Index: opcodes/ChangeLog
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518
KB
2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3@c 1999, 2000, 2001
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
e9c75b65 34@set DATE April 2001
c906108c 35
6d2ebf8b 36@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
c906108c 37
c906108c 38@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 39@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
40@dircategory Programming & development tools.
41@direntry
c906108c 42* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
43@end direntry
44
c906108c
SS
45@ifinfo
46This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
48
5d161b24 49This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
50of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
e9c75b65
EZ
53Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
54 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 55
e9c75b65
EZ
56Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
59Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
60Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
61with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 62
e9c75b65
EZ
63(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
64this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
65Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
66@end ifinfo
67
68@titlepage
69@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
70@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 71@sp 1
c906108c
SS
72@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
73@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 74@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 75@page
c906108c
SS
76@tex
77{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 78\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
79\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
80\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
81}
82@end tex
53a5351d 83
c906108c 84@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
e9c75b65
EZ
85Copyright @copyright{} 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
86 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 87@sp 2
c906108c
SS
88Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
8959 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
90Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 91ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
92
93Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
94under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
95any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
96Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
97Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
98with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
99
100(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
101this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
102Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
103@end titlepage
104@page
105
b9deaee7 106@ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
107@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
108
c906108c
SS
109@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
110
111This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
112
5d161b24 113This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
114@value{GDBVN}.
115
e9c75b65 116Copyright (C) 1988-2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
117
118@menu
119* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
120* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
121
122* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
123* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
124* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
125* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
126* Stack:: Examining the stack
127* Source:: Examining source files
128* Data:: Examining data
b37052ae 129* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
6d2ebf8b
SS
130
131* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
132
133* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
134* Altering:: Altering execution
135* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
136* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
137* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
138* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
139* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
140* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
141* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 142* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
143
144* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
145* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
146
147* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
148* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
149* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
150* Index:: Index
151@end menu
152
b9deaee7 153@end ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
154
155@c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
156
157@ifhtml
158@node Top
159
160@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
161
162This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
163
b37052ae 164This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
6d2ebf8b
SS
165@value{GDBVN}.
166
167Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
168
c906108c
SS
169@menu
170* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 171* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
172
173* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
174* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
175* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
176* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
177* Stack:: Examining the stack
178* Source:: Examining source files
179* Data:: Examining data
c906108c 180
7a292a7a 181* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
182
183* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
184* Altering:: Altering execution
185* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
186* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 187* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
188* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
189* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c906108c 190* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6d2ebf8b 191* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
c906108c
SS
192
193* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 194* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
195
196* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
197* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
198* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
199* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
200@end menu
201
6d2ebf8b
SS
202@end ifhtml
203
449f3b6c
AC
204@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
205@iftex
206@contents
207@end iftex
208
6d2ebf8b 209@node Summary
c906108c
SS
210@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
211
212The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
213going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
214program was doing at the moment it crashed.
215
216@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
217these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
218
219@itemize @bullet
220@item
221Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
222
223@item
224Make your program stop on specified conditions.
225
226@item
227Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
228
229@item
230Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
231effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
232@end itemize
233
cce74817 234You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 235For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
236For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
237
cce74817
JM
238@cindex Chill
239@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 240Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 241see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 242
cce74817
JM
243@cindex Pascal
244Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
245nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
246entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
247syntax.
c906108c 248
c906108c
SS
249@cindex Fortran
250@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 251it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 252underscore.
c906108c 253
c906108c
SS
254@menu
255* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
256* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257@end menu
258
6d2ebf8b 259@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
260@unnumberedsec Free software
261
5d161b24 262@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
263General Public License
264(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273from anyone else.
274
6d2ebf8b 275@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
276@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
277
278Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
279other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
280development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
281of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
282to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
283file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
284blow-by-blow account.
285
286Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
287
288@quotation
289@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
290or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
291omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
292@end quotation
293
294So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
295particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
296releases:
b37052ae 297Andrew Cagney (releases 5.0 and 5.1);
c906108c
SS
298Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
299Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
300Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
301Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
302Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
303John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
304Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
305and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
306
307Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
308Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
309
b37052ae
EZ
310Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
311in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
312Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
313demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
314much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 315
b37052ae 316@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
317object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
318Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
319
320David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
321the original support for encapsulated COFF.
322
96c405b3 323Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
324
325Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
326Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
327support.
328Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
329Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
330Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
331David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
332Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
333Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
334Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
335Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
336Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
337Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
338Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
339Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
340Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
341Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
342Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
343
344Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
345
346Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
347libraries.
348
349Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
350about several machine instruction sets.
351
352Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
353remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
354contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
355and RDI targets, respectively.
356
357Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
358command-line editing and command history.
359
7a292a7a
SS
360Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
361Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 362
5d161b24 363Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 364He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 365symbols.
c906108c
SS
366
367Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
368Super-H processors.
369
370NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
371
372Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
373
374Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
375
376Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
377
96a2c332 378Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
379
380Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
381watchpoints.
382
383Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
384
385Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
386
387Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 388nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
389
390The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
391support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 392(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
393compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
394John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
395Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
396information in this manual.
397
b37052ae
EZ
398DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
399Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
400
96a2c332
SS
401Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
402development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
403fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
404Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
405Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
406Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
407Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
408addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
409JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
410Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
411Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
412Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
413Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
414Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
415Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
416
417
6d2ebf8b 418@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
419@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
420
421You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
422However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
423debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
424
425@iftex
426In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
427to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
428@end iftex
429
430@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
431@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
432
433One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
434processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
435quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
436definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
437session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
438then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
439same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
440@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
441procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
442
443@smallexample
444$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
445$ @b{./m4}
446@b{define(foo,0000)}
447
448@b{foo}
4490000
450@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
451
452@b{bar}
4530000
454@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
455
456@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
457@b{baz}
458@b{C-d}
459m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
460@end smallexample
461
462@noindent
463Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
464
c906108c
SS
465@smallexample
466$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
467@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
468@c FIXME... format to come out better.
469@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 470 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 471 the conditions.
5d161b24 472There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
473 for details.
474
475@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
476(@value{GDBP})
477@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
478
479@noindent
480@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
481rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
482We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
483that examples fit in this manual.
484
485@smallexample
486(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
487@end smallexample
488
489@noindent
490We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
491Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
492@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
493@code{break} command.
494
495@smallexample
496(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
497Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
498@end smallexample
499
500@noindent
501Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
502control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
503subroutine, the program runs as usual:
504
505@smallexample
506(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
507Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
508@b{define(foo,0000)}
509
510@b{foo}
5110000
512@end smallexample
513
514@noindent
515To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
516suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
517context where it stops.
518
519@smallexample
520@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
521
5d161b24 522Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
523 at builtin.c:879
524879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
525@end smallexample
526
527@noindent
528Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
529the next line of the current function.
530
531@smallexample
532(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
533882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
534 : nil,
535@end smallexample
536
537@noindent
538@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
539by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
540@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
541subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
542
543@smallexample
544(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
545set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
546 at input.c:530
547530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
548@end smallexample
549
550@noindent
551The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
552suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
553shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
554command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
555in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
556stack frame for each active subroutine.
557
558@smallexample
559(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
560#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
561 at input.c:530
5d161b24 562#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
563 at builtin.c:882
564#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
565#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
566 at macro.c:71
567#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
568#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
569@end smallexample
570
571@noindent
572We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
573times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
574falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
575
576@smallexample
577(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5780x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
579(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5800x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
581def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
582(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
583536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
584 : xstrdup(rq);
585(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
586538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
587@end smallexample
588
589@noindent
590The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
591@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
592and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
593(@code{print}) to see their values.
594
595@smallexample
596(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
597$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
598(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
599$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
600@end smallexample
601
602@noindent
603@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
604To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
605surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
606
607@smallexample
608(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
609533 xfree(rquote);
610534
611535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
612 : xstrdup (lq);
613536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
614 : xstrdup (rq);
615537
616538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
617539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
618540 @}
619541
620542 void
621@end smallexample
622
623@noindent
624Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
625@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
626
627@smallexample
628(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
629539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
630(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631540 @}
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
633$3 = 9
634(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
635$4 = 7
636@end smallexample
637
638@noindent
639That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
640@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
641@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
642the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
643any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
644assignments.
645
646@smallexample
647(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
648$5 = 7
649(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
650$6 = 9
651@end smallexample
652
653@noindent
654Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
655@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
656executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
657example that caused trouble initially:
658
659@smallexample
660(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
661Continuing.
662
663@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
664
665baz
6660000
667@end smallexample
668
669@noindent
670Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
671problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
672lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
673
674@smallexample
675@b{C-d}
676Program exited normally.
677@end smallexample
678
679@noindent
680The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
681indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
682session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
683
684@smallexample
685(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
686@end smallexample
c906108c 687
6d2ebf8b 688@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
689@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
690
691This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 692The essentials are:
c906108c 693@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 694@item
53a5351d 695type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 696@item
c906108c
SS
697type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
698@end itemize
699
700@menu
701* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
702* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
703* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
704@end menu
705
6d2ebf8b 706@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
707@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
708
c906108c
SS
709Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
710@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
711
712You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
713to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
714
c906108c
SS
715The command-line options described here are designed
716to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 717options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
718
719The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
720specifying an executable program:
721
722@example
723@value{GDBP} @var{program}
724@end example
725
c906108c
SS
726@noindent
727You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
728specified:
729
730@example
731@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
732@end example
733
734You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
735to debug a running process:
736
737@example
738@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
739@end example
740
741@noindent
742would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
743named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
744
c906108c 745Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
746complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
747debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
748``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
749will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 750
96a2c332 751You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
752@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
753
754@smallexample
755@value{GDBP} -silent
756@end smallexample
757
758@noindent
759You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
760options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
761
762@noindent
763Type
764
765@example
766@value{GDBP} -help
767@end example
768
769@noindent
770to display all available options and briefly describe their use
771(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
772
773All options and command line arguments you give are processed
774in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
775@samp{-x} option is used.
776
777
778@menu
c906108c
SS
779* File Options:: Choosing files
780* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
781@end menu
782
6d2ebf8b 783@node File Options
c906108c
SS
784@subsection Choosing files
785
2df3850c 786When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
787specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
788the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
789@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
790that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
791@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
792that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
793the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
794
795If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
796such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
797argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
798
799Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
800following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
801them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
802(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
803than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
804
d700128c
EZ
805@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
806@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
807@c it.
808
c906108c
SS
809@table @code
810@item -symbols @var{file}
811@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
812@cindex @code{--symbols}
813@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
814Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
815
816@item -exec @var{file}
817@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
818@cindex @code{--exec}
819@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
820Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
821and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
822
823@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 824@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
825Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
826file.
827
c906108c
SS
828@item -core @var{file}
829@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
830@cindex @code{--core}
831@cindex @code{-c}
c906108c
SS
832Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
833
834@item -c @var{number}
835Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
836(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
837case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
838
839@item -command @var{file}
840@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
841@cindex @code{--command}
842@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
843Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
844Files,, Command files}.
845
846@item -directory @var{directory}
847@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
848@cindex @code{--directory}
849@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
850Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
851
c906108c
SS
852@item -m
853@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
854@cindex @code{--mapped}
855@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
856@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
857supported on all systems.}@*
858If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 859system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
860to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
861program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 862called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
863Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
864and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
865the symbol table from the executable program.
866
867The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
868is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
869table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 870
c906108c
SS
871@item -r
872@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
873@cindex @code{--readnow}
874@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
875Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
876the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
877This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 878
c906108c
SS
879@end table
880
2df3850c 881You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 882order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
883information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
884on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
885but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
886
887@example
2df3850c 888gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 889@end example
c906108c 890
6d2ebf8b 891@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
892@subsection Choosing modes
893
894You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
895batch mode or quiet mode.
896
897@table @code
898@item -nx
899@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
900@cindex @code{--nx}
901@cindex @code{-n}
2df3850c
JM
902Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
903called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
904@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
905options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
906files}.
c906108c
SS
907
908@item -quiet
d700128c 909@itemx -silent
c906108c 910@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
911@cindex @code{--quiet}
912@cindex @code{--silent}
913@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
914``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
915messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
916
917@item -batch
d700128c 918@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
919Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
920command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
921initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
922nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
923in the command files.
924
2df3850c
JM
925Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
926example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
927make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
928
929@example
930Program exited normally.
931@end example
932
933@noindent
2df3850c
JM
934(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
935@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
936mode.
937
938@item -nowindows
939@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
940@cindex @code{--nowindows}
941@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 942``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 943(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
944interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
945
946@item -windows
947@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
948@cindex @code{--windows}
949@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
950If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
951used if possible.
c906108c
SS
952
953@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 954@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
955Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
956instead of the current directory.
957
c906108c
SS
958@item -fullname
959@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
960@cindex @code{--fullname}
961@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
962@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
963subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
964number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
965displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
966recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
967the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
968and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
969@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
970frame.
c906108c 971
d700128c
EZ
972@item -epoch
973@cindex @code{--epoch}
974The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
975@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
976routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
977separate window.
978
979@item -annotate @var{level}
980@cindex @code{--annotate}
981This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
982effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
983(@pxref{Annotations}).
984Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
985together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
986types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
987@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
988maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
989
990@item -async
991@cindex @code{--async}
992Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
993@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
994special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
995commands in parallel with the debugged process being
996run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
997MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
998suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
999control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1000(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1001operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1002yet.)
1003@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1004@c should be removed.
1005
1006When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1007uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1008@samp{-noasync} option.
1009
1010@item -noasync
1011@cindex @code{--noasync}
1012Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1013
2df3850c
JM
1014@item -baud @var{bps}
1015@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1016@cindex @code{--baud}
1017@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1018Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1019interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1020
1021@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1022@itemx -t @var{device}
1023@cindex @code{--tty}
1024@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1025Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1026@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1027
53a5351d
JM
1028@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1029@c @item -tui
d700128c 1030@c @cindex @code{--tui}
53a5351d
JM
1031@c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
1032@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
1033@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
1034@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
1035@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1036
1037@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1038@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1039@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1040@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1041@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1042@c systems.
1043
d700128c
EZ
1044@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1045@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1046Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1047program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1048communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end. For example,
1049@samp{--interpreter=mi} causes @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdbmi
7162c0ca 1050interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}).
d700128c
EZ
1051
1052@item -write
1053@cindex @code{--write}
1054Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1055is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1056(@pxref{Patching}).
1057
1058@item -statistics
1059@cindex @code{--statistics}
1060This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1061memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1062
1063@item -version
1064@cindex @code{--version}
1065This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1066no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1067
c906108c
SS
1068@end table
1069
6d2ebf8b 1070@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1071@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1072@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1073@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1074
1075@table @code
1076@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1077@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1078@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1079@itemx q
1080To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1081@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1082do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1083otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1084error code.
c906108c
SS
1085@end table
1086
1087@cindex interrupt
1088An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1089terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1090returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1091character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1092until a time when it is safe.
1093
c906108c
SS
1094If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1095device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1096(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1097
6d2ebf8b 1098@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1099@section Shell commands
1100
1101If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1102debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1103just use the @code{shell} command.
1104
1105@table @code
1106@kindex shell
1107@cindex shell escape
1108@item shell @var{command string}
1109Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1110If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1111shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1112(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1113@end table
1114
1115The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1116You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1117@value{GDBN}:
1118
1119@table @code
1120@kindex make
1121@cindex calling make
1122@item make @var{make-args}
1123Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1124arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1125@end table
1126
6d2ebf8b 1127@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1128@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1129
1130You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1131name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1132@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1133key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1134show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1135
1136@menu
1137* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1138* Completion:: Command completion
1139* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1140@end menu
1141
6d2ebf8b 1142@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1143@section Command syntax
1144
1145A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1146how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1147arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1148command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1149step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1150with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1151
1152@cindex abbreviation
1153@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1154unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1155documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1156abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1157equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1158names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1159arguments to the @code{help} command.
1160
1161@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1162@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1163A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1164repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1165will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1166repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1167repeat.
1168
1169The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1170@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1171exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1172
1173@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1174output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1175(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1176@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1177repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1178
41afff9a 1179@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1180@cindex comment
1181Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1182nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1183Files,,Command files}).
1184
6d2ebf8b 1185@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1186@section Command completion
1187
1188@cindex completion
1189@cindex word completion
1190@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1191only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1192are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1193commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1194
1195Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1196of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1197word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1198enter it). For example, if you type
1199
1200@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1201@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1202@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1203@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1204@example
1205(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1206@end example
1207
1208@noindent
1209@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1210the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1211
1212@example
1213(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1214@end example
1215
1216@noindent
1217You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1218breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1219@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1220were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1221might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1222to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1223
1224If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1225@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1226characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1227@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1228example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1229begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1230just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1231function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1232example:
1233
1234@example
1235(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1236@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1237make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1238make_abs_section make_function_type
1239make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1240make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1241make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1242(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1243@end example
1244
1245@noindent
1246After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1247partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1248command.
1249
1250If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1251can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1252means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1253key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1254one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1255
1256@cindex quotes in commands
1257@cindex completion of quoted strings
1258Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1259parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1260its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1261situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1262@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1263
c906108c 1264The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1265name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1266overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1267by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1268may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1269that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1270that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1271word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1272@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1273@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1274when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c
SS
1275
1276@example
96a2c332 1277(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1278bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1279(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1280@end example
1281
1282In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1283quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1284completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1285place:
1286
1287@example
1288(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1289@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1290(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1291@end example
1292
1293@noindent
1294In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1295you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1296completion on an overloaded symbol.
1297
d4f3574e 1298For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1299expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1300overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1301see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1302
1303
6d2ebf8b 1304@node Help
c906108c
SS
1305@section Getting help
1306@cindex online documentation
1307@kindex help
1308
5d161b24 1309You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1310using the command @code{help}.
1311
1312@table @code
41afff9a 1313@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1314@item help
1315@itemx h
1316You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1317display a short list of named classes of commands:
1318
1319@smallexample
1320(@value{GDBP}) help
1321List of classes of commands:
1322
2df3850c 1323aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1324breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1325data -- Examining data
c906108c 1326files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1327internals -- Maintenance commands
1328obscure -- Obscure features
1329running -- Running the program
1330stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1331status -- Status inquiries
1332support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1333tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1334 stopping the program
c906108c 1335user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1336
5d161b24 1337Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1338commands in that class.
5d161b24 1339Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1340documentation.
1341Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1342(@value{GDBP})
1343@end smallexample
96a2c332 1344@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1345
1346@item help @var{class}
1347Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1348list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1349help display for the class @code{status}:
1350
1351@smallexample
1352(@value{GDBP}) help status
1353Status inquiries.
1354
1355List of commands:
1356
1357@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1358@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1359info -- Generic command for showing things
1360 about the program being debugged
1361show -- Generic command for showing things
1362 about the debugger
c906108c 1363
5d161b24 1364Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1365documentation.
1366Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1367(@value{GDBP})
1368@end smallexample
1369
1370@item help @var{command}
1371With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1372short paragraph on how to use that command.
1373
6837a0a2
DB
1374@kindex apropos
1375@item apropos @var{args}
1376The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1377commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1378@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1379
1380@smallexample
1381apropos reload
1382@end smallexample
1383
b37052ae
EZ
1384@noindent
1385results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1386
1387@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1388@c @group
1389set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1390 multiple times in one run
1391show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1392 multiple times in one run
1393@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1394@end smallexample
1395
c906108c
SS
1396@kindex complete
1397@item complete @var{args}
1398The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1399for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1400command you want completed. For example:
1401
1402@smallexample
1403complete i
1404@end smallexample
1405
1406@noindent results in:
1407
1408@smallexample
1409@group
2df3850c
JM
1410if
1411ignore
c906108c
SS
1412info
1413inspect
c906108c
SS
1414@end group
1415@end smallexample
1416
1417@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1418@end table
1419
1420In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1421and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1422of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1423manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1424under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1425all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1426
1427@c @group
1428@table @code
1429@kindex info
41afff9a 1430@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1431@item info
1432This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1433program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1434with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1435registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1436You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1437@w{@code{help info}}.
1438
1439@kindex set
1440@item set
5d161b24 1441You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1442@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1443@code{set prompt $}.
1444
1445@kindex show
1446@item show
5d161b24 1447In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1448@value{GDBN} itself.
1449You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1450related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1451system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1452which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1453
1454@kindex info set
1455To display all the settable parameters and their current
1456values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1457@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1458@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1459@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1460@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1461@end table
1462@c @end group
1463
1464Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1465exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1466
1467@table @code
1468@kindex show version
1469@cindex version number
1470@item show version
1471Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1472information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1473@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1474version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1475commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1476system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1477variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1478The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1479@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1480
1481@kindex show copying
1482@item show copying
1483Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1484
1485@kindex show warranty
1486@item show warranty
2df3850c 1487Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1488if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1489
c906108c
SS
1490@end table
1491
6d2ebf8b 1492@node Running
c906108c
SS
1493@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1494
1495When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1496debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1497
1498You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1499of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1500your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1501kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1502
1503@menu
1504* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1505* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1506* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1507* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1508
1509* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1510* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1511* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1512* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1513
1514* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1515* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1516@end menu
1517
6d2ebf8b 1518@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1519@section Compiling for debugging
1520
1521In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1522debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1523is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1524variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1525and addresses in the executable code.
1526
1527To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1528the compiler.
1529
1530Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1531options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1532executables containing debugging information.
1533
53a5351d
JM
1534@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1535without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1536recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1537program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1538in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1539
1540@cindex optimized code, debugging
1541@cindex debugging optimized code
1542When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1543optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1544really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1545exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1546variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1547variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1548
1549Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1550@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1551doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1552please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1553
1554Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1555@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1556format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1557
1558@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1559@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1560@section Starting your program
1561@cindex starting
1562@cindex running
1563
1564@table @code
1565@kindex run
41afff9a 1566@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1567@item run
1568@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1569Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1570You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1571argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1572@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1573(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1574
1575@end table
1576
c906108c
SS
1577If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1578supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1579that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1580@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1581
1582The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1583receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1584information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1585can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1586your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1587divided into four categories:
1588
1589@table @asis
1590@item The @emph{arguments.}
1591Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1592@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1593is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1594(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1595the arguments.
1596In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1597@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1598@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1599
1600@item The @emph{environment.}
1601Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1602use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1603environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1604your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1605
1606@item The @emph{working directory.}
1607Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1608the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1609@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1610
1611@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1612Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1613standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1614in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1615set a different device for your program.
1616@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1617
1618@cindex pipes
1619@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1620pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1621program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1622wrong program.
1623@end table
c906108c
SS
1624
1625When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1626immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1627of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1628stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1629or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1630
1631If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1632time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1633table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1634your current breakpoints.
1635
6d2ebf8b 1636@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1637@section Your program's arguments
1638
1639@cindex arguments (to your program)
1640The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1641@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1642They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1643performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1644@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1645@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1646the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1647
1648On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1649@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1650calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1651the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1652
1653@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1654@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1655
c906108c 1656@table @code
41afff9a 1657@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1658@item set args
1659Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1660@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1661with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1662using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1663it again without arguments.
1664
1665@kindex show args
1666@item show args
1667Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1668@end table
1669
6d2ebf8b 1670@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1671@section Your program's environment
1672
1673@cindex environment (of your program)
1674The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1675their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1676your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1677path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1678the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1679debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1680environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1681
1682@table @code
1683@kindex path
1684@item path @var{directory}
1685Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1686(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1687The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1688You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1689system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1690MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1691is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1692
1693You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1694working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1695use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1696@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1697@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1698@var{directory} to the search path.
1699@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1700@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1701
1702@kindex show paths
1703@item show paths
1704Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1705environment variable).
1706
1707@kindex show environment
1708@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1709Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1710your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1711print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1712your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1713
1714@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1715@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1716Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1717changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1718be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1719any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1720parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1721null value.
1722@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1723@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1724
1725For example, this command:
1726
1727@example
1728set env USER = foo
1729@end example
1730
1731@noindent
d4f3574e 1732tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1733@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1734are not actually required.)
1735
1736@kindex unset environment
1737@item unset environment @var{varname}
1738Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1739program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1740@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1741rather than assigning it an empty value.
1742@end table
1743
d4f3574e
SS
1744@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1745the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1746by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1747@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1748that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1749@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1750your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1751files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1752@file{.profile}.
1753
6d2ebf8b 1754@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1755@section Your program's working directory
1756
1757@cindex working directory (of your program)
1758Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1759working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1760The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1761from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1762working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1763
1764The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1765that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1766specify files}.
1767
1768@table @code
1769@kindex cd
1770@item cd @var{directory}
1771Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1772
1773@kindex pwd
1774@item pwd
1775Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1776@end table
1777
6d2ebf8b 1778@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1779@section Your program's input and output
1780
1781@cindex redirection
1782@cindex i/o
1783@cindex terminal
1784By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1785the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1786to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1787modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1788running your program.
1789
1790@table @code
1791@kindex info terminal
1792@item info terminal
1793Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1794program is using.
1795@end table
1796
1797You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1798redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1799
1800@example
1801run > outfile
1802@end example
1803
1804@noindent
1805starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1806
1807@kindex tty
1808@cindex controlling terminal
1809Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1810with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1811argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1812commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1813process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1814
1815@example
1816tty /dev/ttyb
1817@end example
1818
1819@noindent
1820directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1821default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1822that as their controlling terminal.
1823
1824An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1825effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1826terminal.
1827
1828When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1829command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1830for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1831
6d2ebf8b 1832@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1833@section Debugging an already-running process
1834@kindex attach
1835@cindex attach
1836
1837@table @code
1838@item attach @var{process-id}
1839This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1840outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1841targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1842find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1843or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1844
1845@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1846executing the command.
1847@end table
1848
1849To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1850which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1851programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1852also have permission to send the process a signal.
1853
1854When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1855the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1856the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1857(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1858the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1859Specify Files}.
1860
1861The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1862process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1863with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1864you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1865can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1866process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1867attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1868
1869@table @code
1870@kindex detach
1871@item detach
1872When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1873@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1874the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1875that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1876are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1877@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1878executing the command.
1879@end table
1880
1881If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1882attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1883for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1884control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1885confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1886messages}).
1887
6d2ebf8b 1888@node Kill Process
c906108c 1889@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1890
1891@table @code
1892@kindex kill
1893@item kill
1894Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1895@end table
1896
1897This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1898running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1899is running.
1900
1901On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1902while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1903@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1904outside the debugger.
1905
1906The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1907relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1908executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1909next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1910reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1911breakpoint settings).
1912
6d2ebf8b 1913@node Threads
c906108c 1914@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1915
1916@cindex threads of execution
1917@cindex multiple threads
1918@cindex switching threads
1919In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1920may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1921of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1922the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1923that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1924modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1925registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1926
1927@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1928programs:
1929
1930@itemize @bullet
1931@item automatic notification of new threads
1932@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1933@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 1934@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
1935a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1936@item thread-specific breakpoints
1937@end itemize
1938
c906108c
SS
1939@quotation
1940@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1941@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1942If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1943effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1944from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1945like this:
1946
1947@smallexample
1948(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1949(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1950Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1951see the IDs of currently known threads.
1952@end smallexample
1953@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1954@c doesn't support threads"?
1955@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1956
1957@cindex focus of debugging
1958@cindex current thread
1959The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1960threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1961control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1962This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1963program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1964
41afff9a 1965@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
1966@cindex thread identifier (system)
1967@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1968@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1969@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1970Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1971the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1972form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1973whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1974LynxOS, you might see
1975
1976@example
1977[New process 35 thread 27]
1978@end example
1979
1980@noindent
1981when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1982the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1983further qualifier.
1984
1985@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1986@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1987@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1988@c program?
1989@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1990@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 1991@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
1992
1993@cindex thread number
1994@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1995For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1996number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1997
1998@table @code
1999@kindex info threads
2000@item info threads
2001Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2002program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2003
2004@enumerate
2005@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2006
2007@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2008
2009@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2010@end enumerate
2011
2012@noindent
2013An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2014indicates the current thread.
2015
5d161b24 2016For example,
c906108c
SS
2017@end table
2018@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2019
2020@smallexample
2021(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2022 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2023 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2024* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2025 at threadtest.c:68
2026@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2027
2028On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2029
2030@cindex thread number
2031@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2032For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2033number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2034thread in your program.
2035
41afff9a
EZ
2036@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2037@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2038@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2039@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2040@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2041Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2042both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2043form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2044whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2045HP-UX, you see
2046
2047@example
2048[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2049@end example
2050
2051@noindent
5d161b24 2052when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2053
2054@table @code
2055@kindex info threads
2056@item info threads
2057Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2058program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2059
2060@enumerate
2061@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2062
2063@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2064
2065@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2066@end enumerate
2067
2068@noindent
2069An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2070indicates the current thread.
2071
5d161b24 2072For example,
c906108c
SS
2073@end table
2074@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2075
2076@example
2077(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2078 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2079 at quicksort.c:137
2080 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2081 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2082 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2083 from /usr/lib/libc.2
c906108c 2084@end example
c906108c
SS
2085
2086@table @code
2087@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2088@item thread @var{threadno}
2089Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2090argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2091shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2092@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2093you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2094
2095@smallexample
2096@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2097(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2098[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
20990x34e5 in sigpause ()
2100@end smallexample
2101
2102@noindent
2103As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2104@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2105threads.
c906108c
SS
2106
2107@kindex thread apply
2108@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2109The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2110more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2111with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2112@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2113threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2114@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2115@end table
2116
2117@cindex automatic thread selection
2118@cindex switching threads automatically
2119@cindex threads, automatic switching
2120Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2121signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2122signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2123message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2124thread.
2125
2126@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2127more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2128programs with multiple threads.
2129
2130@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2131watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2132
6d2ebf8b 2133@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2134@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2135
2136@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2137@cindex multiple processes
2138@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2139On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2140programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2141function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2142parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2143set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2144will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2145will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2146
2147However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2148which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2149the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2150only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2151so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2152on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2153get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2154@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2155the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2156the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2157
53a5351d
JM
2158On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2159debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2160@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2161
2162By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2163the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2164
2165If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2166use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2167
2168@table @code
2169@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2170@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2171Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2172@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2173process. The @var{mode} can be:
2174
2175@table @code
2176@item parent
2177The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2178unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2179
2180@item child
2181The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2182unimpeded.
2183
2184@item ask
2185The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2186@end table
2187
2188@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2189Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2190@end table
2191
2192If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2193@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2194breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2195@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2196the child process's @code{main}.
2197
2198When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2199child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2200
2201If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2202call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2203use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2204argument.
2205
2206You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2207a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2208Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2209
6d2ebf8b 2210@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2211@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2212
2213The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2214program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2215trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2216
7a292a7a
SS
2217Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2218such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2219@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2220change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2221continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2222ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2223explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2224
2225@table @code
2226@kindex info program
2227@item info program
2228Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2229running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2230@end table
2231
2232@menu
2233* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2234* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2235* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2236* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2237@end menu
2238
6d2ebf8b 2239@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2240@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2241
2242@cindex breakpoints
2243A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2244the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2245control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2246breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2247Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2248should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2249program.
2250
2251In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2252breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2253a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2254is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2255not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2256arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2257
2258@cindex watchpoints
2259@cindex memory tracing
2260@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2261@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2262A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2263when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2264command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2265watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2266any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2267and watchpoints using the same commands.
2268
2269You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2270whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2271Automatic display}.
2272
2273@cindex catchpoints
2274@cindex breakpoint on events
2275A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2276when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2277exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2278different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2279catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2280other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2281@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2282
2283@cindex breakpoint numbers
2284@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2285@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2286catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2287starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2288features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2289breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2290@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2291enable it again.
2292
c5394b80
JM
2293@cindex breakpoint ranges
2294@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2295Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2296operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2297@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2298hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2299all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2300
c906108c
SS
2301@menu
2302* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2303* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2304* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2305* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2306* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2307* Conditions:: Break conditions
2308* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2309* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2310* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2311@end menu
2312
6d2ebf8b 2313@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2314@subsection Setting breakpoints
2315
5d161b24 2316@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2317@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2318@c
2319@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2320
2321@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2322@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2323@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2324@cindex latest breakpoint
2325Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2326@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2327number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2328Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2329convenience variables.
2330
2331You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2332
2333@table @code
2334@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2335Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2336When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2337C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2338@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2339
2340@item break +@var{offset}
2341@itemx break -@var{offset}
2342Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2343at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2344(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2345
2346@item break @var{linenum}
2347Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2348The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2349The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2350code on that line.
2351
2352@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2353Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2354
2355@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2356Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2357@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2358superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2359functions.
2360
2361@item break *@var{address}
2362Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2363breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2364information or source files.
2365
2366@item break
2367When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2368the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2369(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2370innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2371returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2372@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2373that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2374@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2375the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2376inside loops.
2377
2378@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2379least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2380would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2381breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2382existed when your program stopped.
2383
2384@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2385Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2386@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2387value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2388@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2389above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2390,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2391
2392@kindex tbreak
2393@item tbreak @var{args}
2394Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2395same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2396way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2397program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2398
c906108c
SS
2399@kindex hbreak
2400@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2401Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2402@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2403breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2404have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2405debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2406changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2407provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2408will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2409address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2410breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2411example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2412@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2413or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2414(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2415
2416@kindex thbreak
2417@item thbreak @var{args}
2418Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2419are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2420the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2421the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2422first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2423command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2424may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2425See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2426
2427@kindex rbreak
2428@cindex regular expression
2429@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2430Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2431@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2432matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2433breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2434the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2435them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2436
2437The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2438like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2439shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2440an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2441@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2442match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2443
b37052ae 2444When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2445breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2446classes.
c906108c
SS
2447
2448@kindex info breakpoints
2449@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2450@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2451@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2452@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2453Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2454not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2455
2456@table @emph
2457@item Breakpoint Numbers
2458@item Type
2459Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2460@item Disposition
2461Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2462@item Enabled or Disabled
2463Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2464that are not enabled.
2465@item Address
2df3850c 2466Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2467@item What
2468Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2469line number.
2470@end table
2471
2472@noindent
2473If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2474the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2475are listed after that.
2476
2477@noindent
2478@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2479number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2480convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2481the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2482listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2483
2484@noindent
2485@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2486has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2487@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2488hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2489was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2490will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2491@end table
2492
2493@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2494your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2495the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2496(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2497
2498@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2499@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2500@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2501purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2502These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2503@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2504
2505You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2506@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2507
2508@table @code
2509@kindex maint info breakpoints
2510@item maint info breakpoints
2511Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2512breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2513internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2514breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2515is shown:
2516
2517@table @code
2518@item breakpoint
2519Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2520
2521@item watchpoint
2522Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2523
2524@item longjmp
2525Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2526@code{longjmp} calls.
2527
2528@item longjmp resume
2529Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2530
2531@item until
2532Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2533
2534@item finish
2535Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2536
c906108c
SS
2537@item shlib events
2538Shared library events.
53a5351d 2539
c906108c 2540@end table
53a5351d 2541
c906108c
SS
2542@end table
2543
2544
6d2ebf8b 2545@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2546@subsection Setting watchpoints
2547
2548@cindex setting watchpoints
2549@cindex software watchpoints
2550@cindex hardware watchpoints
2551You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2552expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2553this may happen.
2554
2555Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2556hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2557program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2558times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2559catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2560culprit.)
2561
d4f3574e 2562On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2563@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2564hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2565program.
2566
2567@table @code
2568@kindex watch
2569@item watch @var{expr}
2570Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2571is written into by the program and its value changes.
2572
2573@kindex rwatch
2574@item rwatch @var{expr}
2575Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2576
2577@kindex awatch
2578@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2579Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2580by the program.
c906108c
SS
2581
2582@kindex info watchpoints
2583@item info watchpoints
2584This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2585it is the same as @code{info break}.
2586@end table
2587
2588@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2589watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2590value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2591cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2592executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2593statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2594
2595When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2596
2597@example
2598Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2599@end example
2600
2601@noindent
2602if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2603
7be570e7
JM
2604Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2605hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2606value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2607every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2608that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2609hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2610will print a message like this:
2611
2612@smallexample
2613Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2614@end smallexample
2615
2616Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2617data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2618watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2619can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2620cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2621double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2622wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2623into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2624
2625If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2626to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2627Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2628time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2629able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2630warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2631
2632@smallexample
2633Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2634@end smallexample
2635
2636@noindent
2637If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2638
2639The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2640or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2641data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2642hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2643both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2644watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2645@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2646watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2647@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2648Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2649
2650If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2651any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2652kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2653
7be570e7
JM
2654@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2655(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2656they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2657which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2658being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2659and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2660rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2661way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2662@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2663
c906108c
SS
2664@quotation
2665@cindex watchpoints and threads
2666@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2667@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2668usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2669can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2670you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2671thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2672can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2673@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2674the expression.
53a5351d 2675
d4f3574e 2676@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2677@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2678have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2679watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2680single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2681change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2682confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2683software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2684when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2685watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2686@end quotation
c906108c 2687
6d2ebf8b 2688@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2689@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2690@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2691@cindex exception handlers
2692@cindex event handling
2693
2694You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2695kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2696shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2697
2698@table @code
2699@kindex catch
2700@item catch @var{event}
2701Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2702@table @code
2703@item throw
2704@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2705The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2706
2707@item catch
2708@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2709The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2710
2711@item exec
2712@kindex catch exec
2713A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2714
2715@item fork
2716@kindex catch fork
2717A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2718
2719@item vfork
2720@kindex catch vfork
2721A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2722
2723@item load
2724@itemx load @var{libname}
2725@kindex catch load
2726The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2727@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2728
2729@item unload
2730@itemx unload @var{libname}
2731@kindex catch unload
2732The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2733of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2734@end table
2735
2736@item tcatch @var{event}
2737Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2738automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2739
2740@end table
2741
2742Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2743
b37052ae 2744There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2745(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2746
2747@itemize @bullet
2748@item
2749If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2750control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2751raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2752returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2753simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2754that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2755you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2756disabled within interactive calls.
2757
2758@item
2759You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2760
2761@item
2762You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2763@end itemize
2764
2765@cindex raise exceptions
2766Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2767if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2768stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2769can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2770breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2771out where the exception was raised.
2772
2773To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2774knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2775raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2776which has the following ANSI C interface:
2777
2778@example
2779 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2780 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2781 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2782@end example
2783
2784@noindent
2785To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2786unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2787(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2788
2789With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2790that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2791a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2792breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2793raised.
2794
2795
6d2ebf8b 2796@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2797@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2798
2799@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2800@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2801It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2802catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2803to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2804breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2805
2806With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2807where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2808delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2809their breakpoint numbers.
2810
2811It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2812automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2813when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2814
2815@table @code
2816@kindex clear
2817@item clear
2818Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2819selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2820the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2821breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2822
2823@item clear @var{function}
2824@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2825Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2826
2827@item clear @var{linenum}
2828@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2829Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2830
2831@cindex delete breakpoints
2832@kindex delete
41afff9a 2833@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2834@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2835Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2836ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2837breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2838confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2839@end table
2840
6d2ebf8b 2841@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2842@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2843
2844@kindex disable breakpoints
2845@kindex enable breakpoints
2846Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2847prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2848it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2849that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2850
2851You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2852the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2853or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2854@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2855catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2856
2857A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2858states of enablement:
2859
2860@itemize @bullet
2861@item
2862Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2863with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2864@item
2865Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2866@item
2867Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2868disabled.
c906108c
SS
2869@item
2870Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2871immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2872set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2873@end itemize
2874
2875You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2876watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2877
2878@table @code
2879@kindex disable breakpoints
2880@kindex disable
41afff9a 2881@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2882@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2883Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2884listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2885options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2886case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2887@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2888
2889@kindex enable breakpoints
2890@kindex enable
c5394b80 2891@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2892Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2893become effective once again in stopping your program.
2894
c5394b80 2895@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2896Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2897of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2898
c5394b80 2899@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2900Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2901deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2902@end table
2903
d4f3574e
SS
2904@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2905@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2906Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2907,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2908subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2909the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2910breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2911breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2912stepping}.)
2913
6d2ebf8b 2914@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2915@subsection Break conditions
2916@cindex conditional breakpoints
2917@cindex breakpoint conditions
2918
2919@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2920@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2921The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2922specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2923breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2924programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2925a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2926and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2927
2928This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2929situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2930when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2931by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2932@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2933
2934Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2935since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2936it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2937and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2938one.
2939
2940Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2941your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2942that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2943format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2944unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2945that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2946program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2947breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2948conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2949purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2950(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2951
2952Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2953@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2954Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2955with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2956
c906108c
SS
2957You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2958The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2959@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2960catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2961
2962@table @code
2963@kindex condition
2964@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2965Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2966watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2967breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2968@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2969@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2970syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2971referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2972symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2973prints an error message:
2974
2975@example
2976No symbol "foo" in current context.
2977@end example
2978
2979@noindent
c906108c
SS
2980@value{GDBN} does
2981not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
2982command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2983@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
2984
2985@item condition @var{bnum}
2986Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2987an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2988@end table
2989
2990@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2991A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2992breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2993useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2994count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2995is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2996therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2997ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2998the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2999value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3000your program reaches it.
3001
3002@table @code
3003@kindex ignore
3004@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3005Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3006The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3007execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3008takes no action.
3009
3010To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3011a count of zero.
3012
3013When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3014breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3015@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3016Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3017
3018If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3019condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3020@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3021
3022You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3023as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3024is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3025variables}.
3026@end table
3027
3028Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3029
3030
6d2ebf8b 3031@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3032@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3033
3034@cindex breakpoint commands
3035You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3036commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3037example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3038enable other breakpoints.
3039
3040@table @code
3041@kindex commands
3042@kindex end
3043@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3044@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3045@itemx end
3046Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3047themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3048@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3049
3050To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3051follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3052
3053With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3054breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3055recently encountered).
3056@end table
3057
3058Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3059disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3060
3061You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3062use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3063that resumes execution.
3064
3065Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3066execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3067(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3068another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3069ambiguities about which list to execute.
3070
3071@kindex silent
3072If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3073usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3074be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3075then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3076see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3077meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3078
3079The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3080print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3081breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3082
3083For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3084value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3085
3086@example
3087break foo if x>0
3088commands
3089silent
3090printf "x is %d\n",x
3091cont
3092end
3093@end example
3094
3095One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3096you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3097of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3098erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3099to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3100so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3101command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3102
3103@example
3104break 403
3105commands
3106silent
3107set x = y + 4
3108cont
3109end
3110@end example
3111
6d2ebf8b 3112@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3113@subsection Breakpoint menus
3114@cindex overloading
3115@cindex symbol overloading
3116
b37052ae 3117Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3118to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3119This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3120@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3121a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3122something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3123particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3124you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3125waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3126options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3127sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3128@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3129breakpoints.
3130
3131For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3132breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3133We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3134
3135@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3136@smallexample
3137@group
3138(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3139[0] cancel
3140[1] all
3141[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3142[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3143[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3144[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3145[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3146[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3147> 2 4 6
3148Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3149Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3150Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3151Multiple breakpoints were set.
3152Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3153 breakpoints.
3154(@value{GDBP})
3155@end group
3156@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3157
3158@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3159@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3160@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3161@c
3162@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3163@c
d4f3574e
SS
3164Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3165any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3166attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3167@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3168
3169@example
3170Cannot insert breakpoints.
3171The same program may be running in another process.
3172@end example
3173
3174When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3175
3176@enumerate
3177@item
3178Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3179
3180@item
5d161b24 3181Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3182name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3183that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3184Then start your program again.
3185
3186@item
3187Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3188linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3189to nonsharable executables.
3190@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3191@c @end ifclear
3192
d4f3574e
SS
3193A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3194hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3195
3196@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3197@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3198@smallexample
3199Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3200You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3201@end smallexample
3202
3203@noindent
3204This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3205only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3206watchpoints it needs to insert.
3207
3208When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3209hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3210
3211
6d2ebf8b 3212@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3213@section Continuing and stepping
3214
3215@cindex stepping
3216@cindex continuing
3217@cindex resuming execution
3218@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3219completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3220one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3221line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3222particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3223your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3224it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3225@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3226
3227@table @code
3228@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3229@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3230@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3231@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3232@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3233@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3234Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3235any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3236@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3237ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3238@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3239
3240The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3241stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3242@code{continue} is ignored.
3243
d4f3574e
SS
3244The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3245debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3246purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3247@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3248@end table
3249
3250To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3251(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3252calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3253different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3254
3255A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3256(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3257beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3258is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3259and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3260interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3261
3262@table @code
3263@kindex step
41afff9a 3264@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3265@item step
3266Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3267line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3268abbreviated @code{s}.
3269
3270@quotation
3271@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3272@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3273@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3274@c distinction here.
3275@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3276within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3277execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3278debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3279is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3280without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3281below.
3282@end quotation
3283
4a92d011
EZ
3284The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3285line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3286@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3287to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3288the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3289called within the line.
c906108c 3290
d4f3574e
SS
3291Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3292number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3293@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3294on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3295was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3296
3297@item step @var{count}
3298Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3299breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3300@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3301
3302@kindex next
41afff9a 3303@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3304@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3305Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3306This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3307the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3308control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3309that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3310is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3311
3312An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3313
3314
3315@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3316@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3317@c
3318@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3319@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3320@c function are executed without stopping.
3321
d4f3574e
SS
3322The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3323source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3324@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3325
b90a5f51
CF
3326@kindex set step-mode
3327@item set step-mode
3328@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3329@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3330@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3331The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3332stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3333information rather than stepping over it.
3334
4a92d011
EZ
3335This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3336machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3337want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3338
3339@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3340Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3341debug information. This is the default.
3342
c906108c
SS
3343@kindex finish
3344@item finish
3345Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3346returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3347
3348Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3349,Returning from a function}).
3350
3351@kindex until
41afff9a 3352@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3353@item until
3354@itemx u
3355Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3356current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3357stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3358command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3359automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3360than the address of the jump.
3361
3362This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3363though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3364exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3365simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3366through the next iteration.
3367
3368@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3369stack frame.
3370
3371@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3372of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3373example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3374(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3375@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3376
3377@example
3378(@value{GDBP}) f
3379#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3380206 expand_input();
3381(@value{GDBP}) until
3382195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3383@end example
3384
3385This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3386generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3387start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3388written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3389to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3390expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3391statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3392
3393@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3394instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3395argument.
3396
3397@item until @var{location}
3398@itemx u @var{location}
3399Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3400reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3401the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3402,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3403and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3404
3405@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3406@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3407@item stepi
96a2c332 3408@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3409@itemx si
3410Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3411
3412It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3413instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3414instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3415Display,, Automatic display}.
3416
3417An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3418
3419@need 750
3420@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3421@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3422@item nexti
96a2c332 3423@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3424@itemx ni
3425Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3426proceed until the function returns.
3427
3428An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3429@end table
3430
6d2ebf8b 3431@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3432@section Signals
3433@cindex signals
3434
3435A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3436operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3437kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3438signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3439@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3440memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3441the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3442requested an alarm).
3443
3444@cindex fatal signals
3445Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3446functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3447errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3448program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3449@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3450fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3451
3452@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3453program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3454signal.
3455
3456@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3457Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3458@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3459(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3460but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3461You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3462
3463@table @code
3464@kindex info signals
3465@item info signals
96a2c332 3466@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3467Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3468handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3469the defined types of signals.
3470
d4f3574e 3471@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3472
3473@kindex handle
3474@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3475Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3476can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3477@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3478@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3479known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3480@end table
3481
3482@c @group
3483The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3484Their full names are:
3485
3486@table @code
3487@item nostop
3488@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3489still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3490
3491@item stop
3492@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3493the @code{print} keyword as well.
3494
3495@item print
3496@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3497
3498@item noprint
3499@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3500implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3501
3502@item pass
5ece1a18 3503@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3504@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3505can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3506and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3507
3508@item nopass
5ece1a18 3509@itemx ignore
c906108c 3510@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3511@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3512@end table
3513@c @end group
3514
d4f3574e
SS
3515When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3516program until you
c906108c
SS
3517continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3518effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3519after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3520command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3521program sees that signal when you continue.
3522
24f93129
EZ
3523The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3524non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3525@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3526erroneous signals.
3527
c906108c
SS
3528You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3529seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3530or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3531due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3532values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3533execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3534a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3535you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3536program a signal}.
c906108c 3537
6d2ebf8b 3538@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3539@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3540
3541When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3542programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3543breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3544
3545@table @code
3546@cindex breakpoints and threads
3547@cindex thread breakpoints
3548@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3549@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3550@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3551@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3552writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3553
3554Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3555to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3556particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3557numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3558column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3559
3560If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3561breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3562program.
3563
3564You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3565well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3566breakpoint condition, like this:
3567
3568@smallexample
2df3850c 3569(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3570@end smallexample
3571
3572@end table
3573
3574@cindex stopped threads
3575@cindex threads, stopped
3576Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3577@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3578allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3579switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3580underfoot.
3581
3582@cindex continuing threads
3583@cindex threads, continuing
3584Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3585executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3586like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3587
3588In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3589Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3590system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3591execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3592single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3593statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3594stops.
3595
3596You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3597continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3598thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3599first thread completes whatever you requested.
3600
3601On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3602thread to run.
3603
3604@table @code
3605@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3606Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3607locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3608current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3609mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3610``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3611stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3612when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3613function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3614like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3615thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3616@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3617
3618@item show scheduler-locking
3619Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3620@end table
3621
c906108c 3622
6d2ebf8b 3623@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3624@chapter Examining the Stack
3625
3626When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3627stopped and how it got there.
3628
3629@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3630Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3631is generated.
3632That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3633the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3634and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3635The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3636The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3637stack}.
3638
3639When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3640stack allow you to see all of this information.
3641
3642@cindex selected frame
3643One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3644@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3645particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3646your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3647special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3648interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3649
3650When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3651currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3652@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3653
3654@menu
3655* Frames:: Stack frames
3656* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3657* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3658* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3659
3660@end menu
3661
6d2ebf8b 3662@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3663@section Stack frames
3664
d4f3574e 3665@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3666@cindex stack frame
3667The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3668frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3669with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3670to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3671which the function is executing.
3672
3673@cindex initial frame
3674@cindex outermost frame
3675@cindex innermost frame
3676When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3677function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3678@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3679made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3680is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3681the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3682actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3683recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3684
3685@cindex frame pointer
3686Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3687stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3688kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3689address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3690in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3691going on in that frame.
3692
3693@cindex frame number
3694@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3695zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3696and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3697they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3698frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3699
6d2ebf8b
SS
3700@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3701@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3702@cindex frameless execution
3703Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b
SS
3704without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3705@example
3706@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3707@end example
3708generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3709This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3710the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3711with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3712has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3713it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3714correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3715no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3716
3717@table @code
d4f3574e 3718@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3719@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3720@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3721The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3722and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3723address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3724@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3725
3726@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3727@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3728@item select-frame
3729The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3730to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3731@code{frame}.
3732@end table
3733
6d2ebf8b 3734@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3735@section Backtraces
3736
3737@cindex backtraces
3738@cindex tracebacks
3739@cindex stack traces
3740A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3741line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3742frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3743stack.
3744
3745@table @code
3746@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3747@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3748@item backtrace
3749@itemx bt
3750Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3751frames in the stack.
3752
3753You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3754character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3755
3756@item backtrace @var{n}
3757@itemx bt @var{n}
3758Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3759
3760@item backtrace -@var{n}
3761@itemx bt -@var{n}
3762Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3763@end table
3764
3765@kindex where
3766@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3767@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3768The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3769are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3770
3771Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3772The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3773print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3774line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3775counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3776line number.
3777
3778Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3779@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3780
3781@smallexample
3782@group
5d161b24 3783#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3784 at builtin.c:993
3785#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3786#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3787 at macro.c:71
3788(More stack frames follow...)
3789@end group
3790@end smallexample
3791
3792@noindent
3793The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3794value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3795code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3796
6d2ebf8b 3797@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3798@section Selecting a frame
3799
3800Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3801whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3802selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3803of the stack frame just selected.
3804
3805@table @code
d4f3574e 3806@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3807@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3808@item frame @var{n}
3809@itemx f @var{n}
3810Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3811(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3812innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3813@code{main}.
3814
3815@item frame @var{addr}
3816@itemx f @var{addr}
3817Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3818chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3819impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3820addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3821switches between them.
3822
c906108c
SS
3823On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3824select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3825
3826On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3827pointer and a program counter.
3828
3829On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3830pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3831@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3832@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3833@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3834
3835@kindex up
3836@item up @var{n}
3837Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3838advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3839that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3840
3841@kindex down
41afff9a 3842@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3843@item down @var{n}
3844Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3845advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3846that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3847abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3848@end table
3849
3850All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3851frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3852arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3853frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3854
3855@need 1000
3856For example:
3857
3858@smallexample
3859@group
3860(@value{GDBP}) up
3861#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3862 at env.c:10
386310 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3864@end group
3865@end smallexample
3866
3867After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3868prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3869@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3870
3871@table @code
3872@kindex down-silently
3873@kindex up-silently
3874@item up-silently @var{n}
3875@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3876These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3877respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3878causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3879in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3880distracting.
3881@end table
3882
6d2ebf8b 3883@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3884@section Information about a frame
3885
3886There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3887stack frame.
3888
3889@table @code
3890@item frame
3891@itemx f
3892When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3893frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3894selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3895argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3896@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3897
3898@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3899@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3900@item info frame
3901@itemx info f
3902This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3903including:
3904
3905@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3906@item
3907the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3908@item
3909the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3910@item
3911the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3912@item
3913the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3914@item
3915the address of the frame's arguments
3916@item
d4f3574e
SS
3917the address of the frame's local variables
3918@item
c906108c
SS
3919the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3920@item
3921which registers were saved in the frame
3922@end itemize
3923
3924@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3925something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3926the usual conventions.
3927
3928@item info frame @var{addr}
3929@itemx info f @var{addr}
3930Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3931selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3932command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3933architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3934@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3935
3936@kindex info args
3937@item info args
3938Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3939
3940@item info locals
3941@kindex info locals
3942Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3943line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3944accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3945
c906108c 3946@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3947@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3948@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3949@item info catch
3950Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3951current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3952exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3953@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3954@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3955
c906108c
SS
3956@end table
3957
c906108c 3958
6d2ebf8b 3959@node Source
c906108c
SS
3960@chapter Examining Source Files
3961
3962@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3963information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3964used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3965the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3966(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3967execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3968source files by explicit command.
3969
7a292a7a 3970If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3971prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3972@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3973
3974@menu
3975* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3976* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
3977* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3978* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3979@end menu
3980
6d2ebf8b 3981@node List
c906108c
SS
3982@section Printing source lines
3983
3984@kindex list
41afff9a 3985@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 3986To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 3987(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
3988There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3989
3990Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3991
3992@table @code
3993@item list @var{linenum}
3994Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3995current source file.
3996
3997@item list @var{function}
3998Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3999@var{function}.
4000
4001@item list
4002Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4003@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4004printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4005as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4006Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4007
4008@item list -
4009Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4010@end table
4011
4012By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4013the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4014
4015@table @code
4016@kindex set listsize
4017@item set listsize @var{count}
4018Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4019the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4020
4021@kindex show listsize
4022@item show listsize
4023Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4024@end table
4025
4026Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4027so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4028than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4029argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4030each repetition moves up in the source file.
4031
4032@cindex linespec
4033In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4034@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4035of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4036Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4037
4038@table @code
4039@item list @var{linespec}
4040Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4041
4042@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4043Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4044linespecs.
4045
4046@item list ,@var{last}
4047Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4048
4049@item list @var{first},
4050Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4051
4052@item list +
4053Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4054
4055@item list -
4056Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4057
4058@item list
4059As described in the preceding table.
4060@end table
4061
4062Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4063kinds of linespec.
4064
4065@table @code
4066@item @var{number}
4067Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4068When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4069the same source file as the first linespec.
4070
4071@item +@var{offset}
4072Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4073When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4074two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4075first linespec.
4076
4077@item -@var{offset}
4078Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4079
4080@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4081Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4082
4083@item @var{function}
4084Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4085For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4086
4087@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4088Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4089function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4090file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4091identically named functions in different source files.
4092
4093@item *@var{address}
4094Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4095@var{address} may be any expression.
4096@end table
4097
6d2ebf8b 4098@node Search
c906108c
SS
4099@section Searching source files
4100@cindex searching
4101@kindex reverse-search
4102
4103There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4104regular expression.
4105
4106@table @code
4107@kindex search
4108@kindex forward-search
4109@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4110@itemx search @var{regexp}
4111The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4112starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4113@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4114synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4115@code{fo}.
4116
4117@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4118The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4119with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4120for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4121this command as @code{rev}.
4122@end table
c906108c 4123
6d2ebf8b 4124@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4125@section Specifying source directories
4126
4127@cindex source path
4128@cindex directories for source files
4129Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4130files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4131the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4132session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4133this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4134it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4135in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4136the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4137the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4138path.
4139
4140If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4141object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4142too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4143compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4144last resort.
4145
4146Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4147any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4148each line is in the file.
4149
4150@kindex directory
4151@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4152When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4153and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4154To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4155
4156@table @code
4157@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4158@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4159Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4160directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4161(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4162part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4163whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4164path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4165
4166@kindex cdir
4167@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4168@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4169@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4170@cindex compilation directory
4171@cindex current directory
4172@cindex working directory
4173@cindex directory, current
4174@cindex directory, compilation
4175You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4176directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4177working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4178tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4179session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4180directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4181
4182@item directory
4183Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4184
4185@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4186@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4187
4188@item show directories
4189@kindex show directories
4190Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4191@end table
4192
4193If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4194interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4195versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4196
4197@enumerate
4198@item
4199Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4200
4201@item
4202Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4203directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4204directories in one command.
4205@end enumerate
4206
6d2ebf8b 4207@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4208@section Source and machine code
4209
4210You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4211addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4212a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4213mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4214line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4215well as hex.
4216
4217@table @code
4218@kindex info line
4219@item info line @var{linespec}
4220Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4221source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4222the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4223source lines}).
4224@end table
4225
4226For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4227the object code for the first line of function
4228@code{m4_changequote}:
4229
d4f3574e
SS
4230@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4231@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4232@smallexample
96a2c332 4233(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4234Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4235@end smallexample
4236
4237@noindent
4238We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4239@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4240@smallexample
4241(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4242Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4243@end smallexample
4244
4245@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4246@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4247After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4248is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4249sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4250,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4251convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4252variables}).
4253
4254@table @code
4255@kindex disassemble
4256@cindex assembly instructions
4257@cindex instructions, assembly
4258@cindex machine instructions
4259@cindex listing machine instructions
4260@item disassemble
4261This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4262instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4263program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4264command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4265surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4266(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4267@end table
4268
c906108c
SS
4269The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4270HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4271
4272@smallexample
4273(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4274Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
42750x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
42760x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
42770x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
42780x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
42790x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
42800x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
42810x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
42820x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4283End of assembler dump.
4284@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4285
4286Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4287mnemonics or other syntax.
4288
4289@table @code
d4f3574e 4290@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4291@cindex assembly instructions
4292@cindex instructions, assembly
4293@cindex machine instructions
4294@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4295@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4296@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4297@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4298Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4299program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4300
4301Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4302can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4303The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4304assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4305@end table
4306
4307
6d2ebf8b 4308@node Data
c906108c
SS
4309@chapter Examining Data
4310
4311@cindex printing data
4312@cindex examining data
4313@kindex print
4314@kindex inspect
4315@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4316@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4317@c different window or something like that.
4318The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4319command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4320evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4321program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4322Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4323
4324@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4325@item print @var{expr}
4326@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4327@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4328value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4329you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4330@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4331formats}.
4332
4333@item print
4334@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4335If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4336@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4337conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4338@end table
4339
4340A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4341It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4342specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4343
7a292a7a 4344If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4345fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4346command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4347Table}.
c906108c
SS
4348
4349@menu
4350* Expressions:: Expressions
4351* Variables:: Program variables
4352* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4353* Output Formats:: Output formats
4354* Memory:: Examining memory
4355* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4356* Print Settings:: Print settings
4357* Value History:: Value history
4358* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4359* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4360* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
29e57380 4361* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
c906108c
SS
4362@end menu
4363
6d2ebf8b 4364@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4365@section Expressions
4366
4367@cindex expressions
4368@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4369compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4370by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4371@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4372and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4373by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4374
d4f3574e
SS
4375@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4376the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4377you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4378memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4379
c906108c
SS
4380Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4381this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4382Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4383languages.
4384
4385In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4386expressions regardless of your programming language.
4387
4388Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4389useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4390at that address in memory.
4391@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4392
4393@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4394to programming languages:
4395
4396@table @code
4397@item @@
4398@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4399@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4400
4401@item ::
4402@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4403function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4404
4405@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4406@cindex type casting memory
4407@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4408@cindex casts, to view memory
4409@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4410Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4411memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4412pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4413a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4414normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4415@end table
4416
6d2ebf8b 4417@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4418@section Program variables
4419
4420The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4421in your program.
4422
4423Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4424(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4425
4426@itemize @bullet
4427@item
4428global (or file-static)
4429@end itemize
4430
5d161b24 4431@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4432
4433@itemize @bullet
4434@item
4435visible according to the scope rules of the
4436programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4437@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4438
4439@noindent This means that in the function
4440
4441@example
4442foo (a)
4443 int a;
4444@{
4445 bar (a);
4446 @{
4447 int b = test ();
4448 bar (b);
4449 @}
4450@}
4451@end example
4452
4453@noindent
4454you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4455executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4456examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4457the block where @code{b} is declared.
4458
4459@cindex variable name conflict
4460There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4461scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4462in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4463function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4464happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4465you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4466using the colon-colon notation:
4467
d4f3574e 4468@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4469@iftex
4470@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4471@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4472@end iftex
4473@example
4474@var{file}::@var{variable}
4475@var{function}::@var{variable}
4476@end example
4477
4478@noindent
4479Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4480static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4481make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4482to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4483
4484@example
4485(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4486@end example
4487
b37052ae 4488@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4489This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4490use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4491scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4492@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4493@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4494
4495@cindex wrong values
4496@cindex variable values, wrong
4497@quotation
4498@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4499wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4500scope, and just before exit.
4501@end quotation
4502You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4503This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4504set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4505stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4506values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4507also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4508after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4509variable definitions may be gone.
4510
4511This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4512To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4513when compiling.
4514
d4f3574e
SS
4515@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4516Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4517unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4518opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4519offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4520might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4521happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4522
4523@example
4524No symbol "foo" in current context.
4525@end example
4526
4527To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4528different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4529formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4530supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4531in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4532to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4533debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4534Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4535information.
4536
4537
6d2ebf8b 4538@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4539@section Artificial arrays
4540
4541@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4542@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4543It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4544same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4545dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4546program.
4547
4548You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4549@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4550operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4551and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4552of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4553the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4554argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4555following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4556example. If a program says
4557
4558@example
4559int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4560@end example
4561
4562@noindent
4563you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4564
4565@example
4566p *array@@len
4567@end example
4568
4569The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4570with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4571subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4572Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4573(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4574
4575Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4576This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4577The value need not be in memory:
4578@example
4579(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4580$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4581@end example
4582
4583As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4584@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4585the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4586@example
4587(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4588$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4589@end example
4590
4591Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4592moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4593actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4594of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4595to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4596variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4597interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4598instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4599structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4600in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4601
4602@example
4603set $i = 0
4604p dtab[$i++]->fv
4605@key{RET}
4606@key{RET}
4607@dots{}
4608@end example
4609
6d2ebf8b 4610@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4611@section Output formats
4612
4613@cindex formatted output
4614@cindex output formats
4615By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4616this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4617in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4618at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4619these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4620
4621The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4622already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4623@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4624letters supported are:
4625
4626@table @code
4627@item x
4628Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4629hexadecimal.
4630
4631@item d
4632Print as integer in signed decimal.
4633
4634@item u
4635Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4636
4637@item o
4638Print as integer in octal.
4639
4640@item t
4641Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4642@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4643used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4644see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4645
4646@item a
4647@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4648@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4649Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4650the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4651where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4652
4653@example
4654(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4655$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4656@end example
4657
3d67e040
EZ
4658@noindent
4659The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4660@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4661
c906108c
SS
4662@item c
4663Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4664
4665@item f
4666Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4667using typical floating point syntax.
4668@end table
4669
4670For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4671
4672@example
4673p/x $pc
4674@end example
4675
4676@noindent
4677Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4678names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4679
4680To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4681you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4682expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4683
6d2ebf8b 4684@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4685@section Examining memory
4686
4687You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4688any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4689
4690@cindex examining memory
4691@table @code
41afff9a 4692@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4693@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4694@itemx x @var{addr}
4695@itemx x
4696Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4697@end table
4698
4699@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4700much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4701expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4702If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4703Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4704
4705@table @r
4706@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4707The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4708how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4709@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4710@c 4.1.2.
4711
4712@item @var{f}, the display format
4713The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4714@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4715The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4716The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4717
4718@item @var{u}, the unit size
4719The unit size is any of
4720
4721@table @code
4722@item b
4723Bytes.
4724@item h
4725Halfwords (two bytes).
4726@item w
4727Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4728@item g
4729Giant words (eight bytes).
4730@end table
4731
4732Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4733default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4734@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4735
4736@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4737@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4738memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4739it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4740@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4741@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4742other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4743the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4744starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4745a value from memory).
4746@end table
4747
4748For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4749(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4750starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4751words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4752@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4753
4754Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4755letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4756unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4757specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4758(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4759
4760Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4761and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4762@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4763including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4764alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4765Code,,Source and machine code}.
4766
4767All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4768easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4769you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4770instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4771with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4772the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4773for successive uses of @code{x}.
4774
4775@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4776The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4777in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4778would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4779subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4780@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4781examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4782@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4783the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4784
4785If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4786are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4787address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4788
6d2ebf8b 4789@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4790@section Automatic display
4791@cindex automatic display
4792@cindex display of expressions
4793
4794If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4795(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4796display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4797Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4798to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4799The automatic display looks like this:
4800
4801@example
48022: foo = 38
48033: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4804@end example
4805
4806@noindent
4807This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4808displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4809specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4810whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4811format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4812or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4813supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4814
4815@table @code
4816@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4817@item display @var{expr}
4818Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4819each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4820
4821@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4822
d4f3574e 4823@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4824For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4825count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4826arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4827@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4828
4829@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4830For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4831number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4832be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4833doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4834@end table
4835
4836For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4837instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4838is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4839
4840@table @code
4841@kindex delete display
4842@kindex undisplay
4843@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4844@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4845Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4846
4847@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4848(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4849
4850@kindex disable display
4851@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4852Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4853item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4854enabled again later.
4855
4856@kindex enable display
4857@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4858Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4859again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4860
4861@item display
4862Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4863done when your program stops.
4864
4865@kindex info display
4866@item info display
4867Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4868automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4869values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4870It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4871because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4872@end table
4873
4874If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4875sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4876expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4877variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4878@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4879@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4880continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4881there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4882automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4883is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4884
6d2ebf8b 4885@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4886@section Print settings
4887
4888@cindex format options
4889@cindex print settings
4890@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4891and symbols are printed.
4892
4893@noindent
4894These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4895
4896@table @code
4897@kindex set print address
4898@item set print address
4899@itemx set print address on
4900@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4901traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4902even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4903is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4904@code{set print address on}:
4905
4906@smallexample
4907@group
4908(@value{GDBP}) f
4909#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4910 at input.c:530
4911530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4912@end group
4913@end smallexample
4914
4915@item set print address off
4916Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4917this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4918
4919@smallexample
4920@group
4921(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4922(@value{GDBP}) f
4923#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4924530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4925@end group
4926@end smallexample
4927
4928You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4929dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4930@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4931all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4932
4933@kindex show print address
4934@item show print address
4935Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4936@end table
4937
4938When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4939closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4940identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4941source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4942@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4943you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4944it prints a symbolic address:
4945
4946@table @code
4947@kindex set print symbol-filename
4948@item set print symbol-filename on
4949Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4950symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4951
4952@item set print symbol-filename off
4953Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4954default.
4955
4956@kindex show print symbol-filename
4957@item show print symbol-filename
4958Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4959line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4960@end table
4961
4962Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4963numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4964number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4965
4966Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4967printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4968
4969@table @code
4970@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4971@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4972Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4973offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 4974@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
4975to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4976
4977@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4978@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4979Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4980symbolic address.
4981@end table
4982
4983@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4984@cindex pointer, finding referent
4985If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4986@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4987and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4988@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4989For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4990at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4991
4992@example
4993(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4994(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4995$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4996@end example
4997
4998@quotation
4999@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5000does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5001the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5002@end quotation
5003
5004Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5005
5006@table @code
5007@kindex set print array
5008@item set print array
5009@itemx set print array on
5010Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5011but uses more space. The default is off.
5012
5013@item set print array off
5014Return to compressed format for arrays.
5015
5016@kindex show print array
5017@item show print array
5018Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5019arrays.
5020
5021@kindex set print elements
5022@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5023Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5024If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5025printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5026This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5027When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5028Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5029
5030@kindex show print elements
5031@item show print elements
5032Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5033If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5034
5035@kindex set print null-stop
5036@item set print null-stop
5037Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5038@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5039contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5040The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5041
5042@kindex set print pretty
5043@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5044Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5045per line, like this:
5046
5047@smallexample
5048@group
5049$1 = @{
5050 next = 0x0,
5051 flags = @{
5052 sweet = 1,
5053 sour = 1
5054 @},
5055 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5056@}
5057@end group
5058@end smallexample
5059
5060@item set print pretty off
5061Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5062
5063@smallexample
5064@group
5065$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5066meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5067@end group
5068@end smallexample
5069
5070@noindent
5071This is the default format.
5072
5073@kindex show print pretty
5074@item show print pretty
5075Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5076
5077@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5078@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5079Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5080@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5081character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5082best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5083high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5084
5085@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5086Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5087international character sets, and is the default.
5088
5089@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5090@item show print sevenbit-strings
5091Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5092
5093@kindex set print union
5094@item set print union on
5d161b24 5095Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5096is the default setting.
5097
5098@item set print union off
5099Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5100
5101@kindex show print union
5102@item show print union
5103Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5104structures.
5105
5106For example, given the declarations
5107
5108@smallexample
5109typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5110typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5111typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5112 Bug_forms;
5113
5114struct thing @{
5115 Species it;
5116 union @{
5117 Tree_forms tree;
5118 Bug_forms bug;
5119 @} form;
5120@};
5121
5122struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5123@end smallexample
5124
5125@noindent
5126with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5127
5128@smallexample
5129$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5130@end smallexample
5131
5132@noindent
5133and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5134
5135@smallexample
5136$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5137@end smallexample
5138@end table
5139
c906108c
SS
5140@need 1000
5141@noindent
b37052ae 5142These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5143
5144@table @code
5145@cindex demangling
5146@kindex set print demangle
5147@item set print demangle
5148@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5149Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5150(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5151linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5152
5153@kindex show print demangle
5154@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5155Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5156
5157@kindex set print asm-demangle
5158@item set print asm-demangle
5159@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5160Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5161in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5162The default is off.
5163
5164@kindex show print asm-demangle
5165@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5166Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5167or demangled form.
5168
5169@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5170@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5171@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5172@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5173Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5174represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5175
5176@table @code
5177@item auto
5178Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5179
5180@item gnu
b37052ae 5181Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5182This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5183
5184@item hp
b37052ae 5185Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5186
5187@item lucid
b37052ae 5188Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5189
5190@item arm
b37052ae 5191Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5192@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5193debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5194require further enhancement to permit that.
5195
5196@end table
5197If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5198
5199@kindex show demangle-style
5200@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5201Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5202
5203@kindex set print object
5204@item set print object
5205@itemx set print object on
5206When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5207(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5208the virtual function table.
5209
5210@item set print object off
5211Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5212virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5213
5214@kindex show print object
5215@item show print object
5216Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5217
5218@kindex set print static-members
5219@item set print static-members
5220@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5221Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5222
5223@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5224Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5225
5226@kindex show print static-members
5227@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5228Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5229
5230@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5231@kindex set print vtbl
5232@item set print vtbl
5233@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5234Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5235(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5236ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5237
5238@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5239Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5240
5241@kindex show print vtbl
5242@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5243Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5244@end table
c906108c 5245
6d2ebf8b 5246@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5247@section Value history
5248
5249@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5250Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5251@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5252Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5253(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5254When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5255since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5256symbol table.
5257
5258@cindex @code{$}
5259@cindex @code{$$}
5260@cindex history number
5261The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5262refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5263@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5264printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5265history number.
5266
5267To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5268history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5269remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5270the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5271@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5272is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5273@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5274
5275For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5276want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5277
5278@example
5279p *$
5280@end example
5281
5282If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5283to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5284
5285@example
5286p *$.next
5287@end example
5288
5289@noindent
5290You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5291command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5292
5293Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5294@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5295
5296@example
5297print x
5298set x=5
5299@end example
5300
5301@noindent
5302then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5303remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5304
5305@table @code
5306@kindex show values
5307@item show values
5308Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5309This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5310values} does not change the history.
5311
5312@item show values @var{n}
5313Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5314
5315@item show values +
5316Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5317values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5318@end table
5319
5320Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5321same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5322
6d2ebf8b 5323@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5324@section Convenience variables
5325
5326@cindex convenience variables
5327@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5328@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5329exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5330setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5331of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5332
5333Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5334@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5335the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5336(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5337by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5338
5339You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5340expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5341For example:
5342
5343@example
5344set $foo = *object_ptr
5345@end example
5346
5347@noindent
5348would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5349@code{object_ptr}.
5350
5351Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5352value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5353value with another assignment at any time.
5354
5355Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5356variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5357that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5358variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5359
5360@table @code
5361@kindex show convenience
5362@item show convenience
5363Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5364Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5365@end table
5366
5367One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5368incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5369a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5370
5371@example
5372set $i = 0
5373print bar[$i++]->contents
5374@end example
5375
d4f3574e
SS
5376@noindent
5377Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5378
5379Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5380values likely to be useful.
5381
5382@table @code
41afff9a 5383@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5384@item $_
5385The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5386the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5387commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5388set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5389and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5390except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5391to the type of @code{$__}.
5392
41afff9a 5393@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5394@item $__
5395The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5396to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5397to match the format in which the data was printed.
5398
5399@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5400@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5401The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5402the program being debugged terminates.
5403@end table
5404
53a5351d
JM
5405On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5406begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5407name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5408
6d2ebf8b 5409@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5410@section Registers
5411
5412@cindex registers
5413You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5414with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5415for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5416your machine.
5417
5418@table @code
5419@kindex info registers
5420@item info registers
5421Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5422registers (in the selected stack frame).
5423
5424@kindex info all-registers
5425@cindex floating point registers
5426@item info all-registers
5427Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5428registers.
5429
5430@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5431Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5432As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5433the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5434the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5435@end table
5436
5437@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5438expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5439architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5440@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5441the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5442pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5443register that contains the processor status. For example,
5444you could print the program counter in hex with
5445
5446@example
5447p/x $pc
5448@end example
5449
5450@noindent
5451or print the instruction to be executed next with
5452
5453@example
5454x/i $pc
5455@end example
5456
5457@noindent
5458or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5459one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5460memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5461stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5462stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5463regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5464see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5465
5466@example
5467set $sp += 4
5468@end example
5469
5470Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5471your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5472so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5473shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5474registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5475can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5476is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5477
5478@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5479integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5480special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5481registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5482to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5483(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5484@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5485
5486Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5487means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5488the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5489sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5490coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5491programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5492cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5493that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5494prints the data in both formats.
5495
5496Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5497(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5498value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5499were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5500true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5501frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5502
5503However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5504code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5505@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5506frame makes no difference.
5507
6d2ebf8b 5508@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5509@section Floating point hardware
5510@cindex floating point
5511
5512Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5513you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5514
5515@table @code
5516@kindex info float
5517@item info float
5518Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5519point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5520floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5521the ARM and x86 machines.
5522@end table
c906108c 5523
29e57380
C
5524@node Memory Region Attributes
5525@section Memory Region Attributes
5526@cindex memory region attributes
5527
5528@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5529required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5530to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5531use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5532
5533Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5534memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5535accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5536been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5537all memory.
5538
5539When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5540to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5541
5542@table @code
5543@kindex mem
5544@item mem @var{address1} @var{address1} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5545Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5546with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5547
5548@kindex delete mem
5549@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5550Remove memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5551
5552@kindex disable mem
5553@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5554Disable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5555A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5556It may be enabled again later.
5557
5558@kindex enable mem
5559@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5560Enable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5561
5562@kindex info mem
5563@item info mem
5564Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5565for each region.
5566
5567@table @emph
5568@item Memory Region Number
5569@item Enabled or Disabled.
5570Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5571Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5572
5573@item Lo Address
5574The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5575
5576@item Hi Address
5577The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5578
5579@item Attributes
5580The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5581@end table
5582@end table
5583
5584
5585@subsection Attributes
5586
5587@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5588The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5589write accesses to a memory region.
5590
5591While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5592memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5593etc. from accessing memory.
5594
5595@table @code
5596@item ro
5597Memory is read only.
5598@item wo
5599Memory is write only.
5600@item rw
5601Memory is read/write (default).
5602@end table
5603
5604@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5605The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5606accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5607require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5608specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5609
5610@table @code
5611@item 8
5612Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5613@item 16
5614Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5615@item 32
5616Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5617@item 64
5618Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5619@end table
5620
5621@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5622@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5623@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5624@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5625@c
5626@c @table @code
5627@c @item hwbreak
5628@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5629@c @item swbreak (default)
5630@c @end table
5631
5632@subsubsection Data Cache
5633The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5634memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5635protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5636does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5637registers.
5638
5639@table @code
5640@item cache
5641Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5642@item nocache (default)
5643Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.
5644@end table
5645
5646@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5647@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5648@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5649@c
5650@c @table @code
5651@c @item verify
5652@c @item noverify (default)
5653@c @end table
5654
b37052ae
EZ
5655@node Tracepoints
5656@chapter Tracepoints
5657@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
5658@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
5659
5660@cindex tracepoints
5661In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
5662the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
5663anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
5664depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
5665might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
5666fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
5667to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
5668
5669Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
5670specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
5671arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
5672Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
5673those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
5674expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
5675for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
5676a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
5677in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
5678values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
5679unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
5680
5681The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
5682targets. @xref{Targets}.
5683
5684This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
5685
5686@menu
5687* Set Tracepoints::
5688* Analyze Collected Data::
5689* Tracepoint Variables::
5690@end menu
5691
5692@node Set Tracepoints
5693@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
5694
5695Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
5696tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
5697tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
5698breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
5699one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
5700tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
5701work on.
5702
5703For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
5704of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
5705it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
5706local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
5707commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
5708tracepoint was hit.
5709
5710This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
5711conditions and actions.
5712
5713@menu
5714* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
5715* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
5716* Tracepoint Passcounts::
5717* Tracepoint Actions::
5718* Listing Tracepoints::
5719* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
5720@end menu
5721
5722@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
5723@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
5724
5725@table @code
5726@cindex set tracepoint
5727@kindex trace
5728@item trace
5729The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
5730Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
5731the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
5732defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
5733debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
5734program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
5735doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
5736cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
5737running.
5738
5739Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
5740
5741@smallexample
5742(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
5743
5744(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
5745
5746(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
5747
5748(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
5749
5750(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
5751@end smallexample
5752
5753@noindent
5754You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
5755
5756@vindex $tpnum
5757@cindex last tracepoint number
5758@cindex recent tracepoint number
5759@cindex tracepoint number
5760The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
5761of the most recently set tracepoint.
5762
5763@kindex delete tracepoint
5764@cindex tracepoint deletion
5765@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5766Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
5767default is to delete all tracepoints.
5768
5769Examples:
5770
5771@smallexample
5772(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
5773
5774(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
5775@end smallexample
5776
5777@noindent
5778You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
5779@end table
5780
5781@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5782@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5783
5784@table @code
5785@kindex disable tracepoint
5786@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5787Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
5788@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
5789the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
5790a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
5791
5792@kindex enable tracepoint
5793@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5794Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
5795tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
5796run.
5797@end table
5798
5799@node Tracepoint Passcounts
5800@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
5801
5802@table @code
5803@kindex passcount
5804@cindex tracepoint pass count
5805@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
5806Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
5807automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
5808@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
5809the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
5810@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
5811passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
5812given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
5813user.
5814
5815Examples:
5816
5817@smallexample
5818(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of tracepoint 2
5819
5820(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
5821 // most recently defined tracepoint.
5822(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5823(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
5824(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
5825(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
5826(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
5827(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
5828 // executed 3 times OR when bar has
5829 // been executed 2 times
5830 // OR when baz has been executed 1 time.
5831@end smallexample
5832@end table
5833
5834@node Tracepoint Actions
5835@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
5836
5837@table @code
5838@kindex actions
5839@cindex tracepoint actions
5840@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5841This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
5842tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
5843specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
5844recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
5845@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
5846actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
5847terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
5848far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
5849@code{while-stepping}.
5850
5851@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
5852To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
5853and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
5854
5855@smallexample
5856(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
5857
5858(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times and collect data
5859
5860(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
5861@end smallexample
5862
5863In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
5864commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
5865hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
5866following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
5867followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
5868@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
5869@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
5870@code{end} command.
5871
5872@smallexample
5873(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5874(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
5875Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
5876> collect bar,baz
5877> collect $regs
5878> while-stepping 12
5879 > collect $fp, $sp
5880 > end
5881end
5882@end smallexample
5883
5884@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
5885@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
5886Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
5887This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
5888In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
5889special arguments are supported:
5890
5891@table @code
5892@item $regs
5893collect all registers
5894
5895@item $args
5896collect all function arguments
5897
5898@item $locals
5899collect all local variables.
5900@end table
5901
5902You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
5903with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
5904arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
5905
f5c37c66
EZ
5906The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
5907particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
5908
b37052ae
EZ
5909@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
5910@item while-stepping @var{n}
5911Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
5912new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
5913followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
5914its own @code{end} command):
5915
5916@smallexample
5917> while-stepping 12
5918 > collect $regs, myglobal
5919 > end
5920>
5921@end smallexample
5922
5923@noindent
5924You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
5925@code{stepping}.
5926@end table
5927
5928@node Listing Tracepoints
5929@subsection Listing Tracepoints
5930
5931@table @code
5932@kindex info tracepoints
5933@cindex information about tracepoints
5934@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5935Display information the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify a
5936tracepoint number displays information about all the tracepoints
5937defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
5938shown:
5939
5940@itemize @bullet
5941@item
5942its number
5943@item
5944whether it is enabled or disabled
5945@item
5946its address
5947@item
5948its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
5949@item
5950its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
5951@item
5952where in the source files is the tracepoint set
5953@item
5954its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
5955@end itemize
5956
5957@smallexample
5958(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
5959Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
59601 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
59612 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in gdb_test at gdb_test.c:375
59623 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in collect_data at ../foo.c:1741
5963(@value{GDBP})
5964@end smallexample
5965
5966@noindent
5967This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
5968@end table
5969
5970@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5971@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5972
5973@table @code
5974@kindex tstart
5975@cindex start a new trace experiment
5976@cindex collected data discarded
5977@item tstart
5978This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
5979begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
5980the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
5981experiment.
5982
5983@kindex tstop
5984@cindex stop a running trace experiment
5985@item tstop
5986This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
5987stops collecting data.
5988
5989@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
5990automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
5991(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
5992
5993@kindex tstatus
5994@cindex status of trace data collection
5995@cindex trace experiment, status of
5996@item tstatus
5997This command displays the status of the current trace data
5998collection.
5999@end table
6000
6001Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6002
6003@smallexample
6004(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6005(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6006Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6007> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6008> while-stepping 11
6009 > collect $regs
6010 > end
6011> end
6012(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6013 [time passes @dots{}]
6014(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6015@end smallexample
6016
6017
6018@node Analyze Collected Data
6019@section Using the collected data
6020
6021After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6022for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6023collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6024snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6025consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6026examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6027specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6028snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6029registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6030rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6031debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6032(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6033behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6034when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6035the buffer will fail.
6036
6037@menu
6038* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6039* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6040* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6041@end menu
6042
6043@node tfind
6044@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6045
6046@kindex tfind
6047@cindex select trace snapshot
6048@cindex find trace snapshot
6049The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6050@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6051counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6052snapshot is selected.
6053
6054Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6055
6056@table @code
6057@item tfind start
6058Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6059@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6060
6061@item tfind none
6062Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6063
6064@item tfind end
6065Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6066
6067@item tfind
6068No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6069
6070@item tfind -
6071Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6072retracing earlier steps.
6073
6074@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6075Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6076proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6077argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6078for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6079
6080@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6081Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6082program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6083snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6084snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6085
6086@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6087Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6088addresses.
6089
6090@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6091Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6092@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6093
6094@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6095Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6096the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6097that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6098trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6099next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6100@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6101stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6102@end table
6103
6104The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6105designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6106instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6107snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6108trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6109simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6110snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6111@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6112The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6113for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6114no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6115(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6116no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6117tracepoint as the current one.
6118
6119In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6120these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6121scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6122you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6123registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6124
6125@smallexample
6126(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6127(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6128> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6129 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6130> tfind
6131> end
6132
6133Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6134Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6135Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6136Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6137Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6138Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6139Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6140Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6141Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6142Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6143Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6144@end smallexample
6145
6146Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6147the buffer:
6148
6149@smallexample
6150(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6151(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6152> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6153> tfind line
6154> end
6155
6156Frame 0, X = 1
6157Frame 7, X = 2
6158Frame 13, X = 255
6159@end smallexample
6160
6161@node tdump
6162@subsection @code{tdump}
6163@kindex tdump
6164@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6165@cindex tracepoint data, display
6166
6167This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6168the current trace snapshot.
6169
6170@smallexample
6171(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6172(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6173Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6174> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6175> end
6176
6177(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6178
6179(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6180#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6181at gdb_test.c:444
6182444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6183
6184(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6185Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6186d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6187d1 0x18 24
6188d2 0x80 128
6189d3 0x33 51
6190d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6191d5 0x22 34
6192d6 0xe0 224
6193d7 0x380035 3670069
6194a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6195a1 0x3000668 50333288
6196a2 0x100 256
6197a3 0x322000 3284992
6198a4 0x3000698 50333336
6199a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6200fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6201sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6202ps 0x0 0
6203pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6204fpcontrol 0x0 0
6205fpstatus 0x0 0
6206fpiaddr 0x0 0
6207p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6208p1 = (void *) 0x11
6209p2 = (void *) 0x22
6210p3 = (void *) 0x33
6211p4 = (void *) 0x44
6212p5 = (void *) 0x55
6213p6 = (void *) 0x66
6214gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6215
6216(@value{GDBP})
6217@end smallexample
6218
6219@node save-tracepoints
6220@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6221@kindex save-tracepoints
6222@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6223
6224This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6225their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6226suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6227tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6228Files}).
6229
6230@node Tracepoint Variables
6231@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6232@cindex tracepoint variables
6233@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6234
6235@table @code
6236@vindex $trace_frame
6237@item (int) $trace_frame
6238The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6239snapshot is selected.
6240
6241@vindex $tracepoint
6242@item (int) $tracepoint
6243The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6244
6245@vindex $trace_line
6246@item (int) $trace_line
6247The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6248
6249@vindex $trace_file
6250@item (char []) $trace_file
6251The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6252
6253@vindex $trace_func
6254@item (char []) $trace_func
6255The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6256@end table
6257
6258Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6259use @code{output} instead.
6260
6261Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6262stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6263data.
6264
6265@smallexample
6266(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6267
6268(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6269> output $trace_file
6270> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6271> tfind
6272> end
6273@end smallexample
6274
6d2ebf8b 6275@node Languages
c906108c
SS
6276@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
6277@cindex languages
6278
c906108c
SS
6279Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
6280rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
6281dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
6282Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 6283represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 6284@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
6285
6286@cindex working language
6287Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
6288allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
6289native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
6290consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
6291language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
6292language}.
6293
6294@menu
6295* Setting:: Switching between source languages
6296* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 6297* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
6298* Support:: Supported languages
6299@end menu
6300
6d2ebf8b 6301@node Setting
c906108c
SS
6302@section Switching between source languages
6303
6304There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
6305set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
6306@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
6307defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
6308used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
6309are printed, etc.
6310
6311In addition to the working language, every source file that
6312@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
6313file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
6314source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
6315language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 6316controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 6317show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
6318set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
6319set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
6320Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
6321
6322This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 6323as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
6324another language. In that case, make the
6325program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
6326@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
6327program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
6328
6329@menu
6330* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
6331* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
6332* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6333@end menu
6334
6d2ebf8b 6335@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
6336@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
6337
6338If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
6339@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
6340
6341@table @file
6342
6343@item .c
6344C source file
6345
6346@item .C
6347@itemx .cc
6348@itemx .cp
6349@itemx .cpp
6350@itemx .cxx
6351@itemx .c++
b37052ae 6352C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
6353
6354@item .f
6355@itemx .F
6356Fortran source file
6357
c906108c
SS
6358@item .ch
6359@itemx .c186
6360@itemx .c286
96a2c332 6361CHILL source file
c906108c 6362
c906108c
SS
6363@item .mod
6364Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
6365
6366@item .s
6367@itemx .S
6368Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
6369@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
6370@end table
6371
6372In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
6373extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
6374
6d2ebf8b 6375@node Manually
c906108c
SS
6376@subsection Setting the working language
6377
6378If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
6379expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
6380your program.
6381
6382@kindex set language
6383If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
6384command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 6385a language, such as
c906108c 6386@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
6387For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
6388
c906108c
SS
6389Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
6390language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
6391to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
6392source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
6393languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
6394source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
6395command such as:
6396
6397@example
6398print a = b + c
6399@end example
6400
6401@noindent
6402might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
6403@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
6404printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
6405@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 6406
6d2ebf8b 6407@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
6408@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6409
6410To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
6411@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
6412then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
6413frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
6414working language to the language recorded for the function in that
6415frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
6416or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
6417does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
6418not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
6419
6420This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
6421entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
6422written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
6423a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
6424case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
6425
6d2ebf8b 6426@node Show
c906108c 6427@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
6428
6429The following commands help you find out which language is the
6430working language, and also what language source files were written in.
6431
6432@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
6433@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
6434@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
6435@table @code
6436@item show language
6437Display the current working language. This is the
6438language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
6439build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
6440
6441@item info frame
5d161b24 6442Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 6443working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 6444@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6445information listed here.
6446
6447@item info source
6448Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 6449@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6450information listed here.
6451@end table
6452
6453In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
6454not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
6455with a language explicitly:
6456
6457@kindex set extension-language
6458@kindex info extensions
6459@table @code
6460@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
6461Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
6462the source language @var{language}.
6463
6464@item info extensions
6465List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
6466@end table
6467
6d2ebf8b 6468@node Checks
c906108c
SS
6469@section Type and range checking
6470
6471@quotation
6472@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
6473checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
6474section documents the intended facilities.
6475@end quotation
6476@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
6477
6478Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
6479errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
6480checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
6481sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
6482these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
6483by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
6484errors when your program is running.
6485
6486@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
6487Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
6488can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
6489the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
6490@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
6491your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
6492for the default settings of supported languages.
6493
6494@menu
6495* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
6496* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
6497@end menu
6498
6499@cindex type checking
6500@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 6501@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
6502@subsection An overview of type checking
6503
6504Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
6505arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
6506otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
6507errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
6508
6509@smallexample
65101 + 2 @result{} 3
6511@exdent but
6512@error{} 1 + 2.3
6513@end smallexample
6514
6515The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
6516type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
6517
5d161b24
DB
6518For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
6519@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
6520to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
6521or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
6522but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
6523these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
6524also issues a warning.
6525
5d161b24
DB
6526Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
6527related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
6528For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
6529a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
6530with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
6531the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
6532
6533Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
6534instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
6535operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
6536represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
6537operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
6538details on specific languages.
6539
6540@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
6541
d4f3574e 6542@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
6543@kindex set check type
6544@kindex show check type
6545@table @code
6546@item set check type auto
6547Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
6548@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6549each language.
6550
6551@item set check type on
6552@itemx set check type off
6553Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6554current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
6555match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 6556evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
6557message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
6558
6559@item set check type warn
6560Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
6561evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
6562be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
6563numbers and structures.
6564
6565@item show type
5d161b24 6566Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6567is setting it automatically.
6568@end table
6569
6570@cindex range checking
6571@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 6572@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
6573@subsection An overview of range checking
6574
6575In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
6576bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
6577checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
6578computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
6579not exceed the bounds of the array.
6580
6581For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
6582@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
6583always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
6584warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
6585
6586A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
6587array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
6588of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
6589error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
6590result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
6591the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
6592
6593@example
6594@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
6595@end example
6596
6597This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
6598specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
6599Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
6600
6601@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
6602
d4f3574e 6603@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
6604@kindex set check range
6605@kindex show check range
6606@table @code
6607@item set check range auto
6608Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
6609@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6610each language.
6611
6612@item set check range on
6613@itemx set check range off
6614Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6615current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
6616match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
6617then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
6618
6619@item set check range warn
6620Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
6621but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
6622expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
6623memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
6624systems).
6625
6626@item show range
6627Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
6628being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
6629@end table
c906108c 6630
6d2ebf8b 6631@node Support
c906108c 6632@section Supported languages
c906108c 6633
b37052ae 6634@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 6635@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
6636Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
6637language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
6638and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
6639,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
6640language.
6641
6642The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
6643supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
6644tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
6645@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
6646formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
6647books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
6648language reference or tutorial.
6649
c906108c 6650@menu
b37052ae 6651* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 6652* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 6653* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
6654@end menu
6655
6d2ebf8b 6656@node C
b37052ae 6657@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 6658
b37052ae
EZ
6659@cindex C and C@t{++}
6660@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 6661
b37052ae 6662Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
6663to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
6664together.
6665
41afff9a
EZ
6666@cindex C@t{++}
6667@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
6668@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
6669The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
6670compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
6671effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
6672C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6673compiler (@code{aCC}).
6674
b37052ae 6675For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
6676format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
6677command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
6678@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
6679CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 6680
c906108c 6681@menu
b37052ae
EZ
6682* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
6683* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
6684* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
6685* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
6686* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 6687* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 6688* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 6689@end menu
c906108c 6690
6d2ebf8b 6691@node C Operators
b37052ae 6692@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 6693
b37052ae 6694@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
6695
6696Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6697@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 6698often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 6699
b37052ae 6700For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
6701
6702@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 6703
c906108c 6704@item
c906108c 6705@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 6706specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
6707
6708@item
d4f3574e
SS
6709@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
6710@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
6711
6712@item
53a5351d 6713@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
6714
6715@item
6716@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 6717
c906108c
SS
6718@end itemize
6719
6720@noindent
6721The following operators are supported. They are listed here
6722in order of increasing precedence:
6723
6724@table @code
6725@item ,
6726The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
6727are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
6728expression being the last expression evaluated.
6729
6730@item =
6731Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
6732assigned. Defined on scalar types.
6733
6734@item @var{op}=
6735Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
6736and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 6737@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
6738@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
6739@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
6740
6741@item ?:
6742The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
6743of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
6744integral type.
6745
6746@item ||
6747Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6748
6749@item &&
6750Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6751
6752@item |
6753Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6754
6755@item ^
6756Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6757
6758@item &
6759Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6760
6761@item ==@r{, }!=
6762Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
6763expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
6764
6765@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
6766Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
6767Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
6768and non-zero for true.
6769
6770@item <<@r{, }>>
6771left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
6772
6773@item @@
6774The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6775
6776@item +@r{, }-
6777Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
6778pointer types.
6779
6780@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
6781Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
6782defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
6783integral types.
6784
6785@item ++@r{, }--
6786Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
6787operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6788when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6789operation takes place.
6790
6791@item *
6792Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
6793@code{++}.
6794
6795@item &
6796Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
6797
b37052ae
EZ
6798For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6799allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 6800(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 6801where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 6802stored.
c906108c
SS
6803
6804@item -
6805Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
6806precedence as @code{++}.
6807
6808@item !
6809Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6810@code{++}.
6811
6812@item ~
6813Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6814@code{++}.
6815
6816
6817@item .@r{, }->
6818Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
6819@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6820pointer based on the stored type information.
6821Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6822
c906108c
SS
6823@item .*@r{, }->*
6824Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
6825
6826@item []
6827Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6828@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6829
6830@item ()
6831Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6832
c906108c 6833@item ::
b37052ae 6834C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 6835and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
6836
6837@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
6838Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6839(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
6840above.
c906108c
SS
6841@end table
6842
c906108c
SS
6843If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6844attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6845predefined meaning.
c906108c 6846
c906108c 6847@menu
5d161b24 6848* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
6849@end menu
6850
6d2ebf8b 6851@node C Constants
b37052ae 6852@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 6853
b37052ae 6854@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 6855
b37052ae 6856@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 6857following ways:
c906108c
SS
6858
6859@itemize @bullet
6860@item
6861Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6862specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6863a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
6864@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6865@code{long} value.
6866
6867@item
6868Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6869point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6870exponent. An exponent is of the form:
6871@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6872sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
6873A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6874@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6875the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6876a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6877constant.
c906108c
SS
6878
6879@item
6880Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6881integral equivalents.
6882
6883@item
6884Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6885(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 6886(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
6887be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6888the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6889of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6890@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6891@samp{\n} for newline.
6892
6893@item
96a2c332
SS
6894String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6895double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
6896above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6897a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6898characters.
c906108c
SS
6899
6900@item
6901Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6902to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6903
6904@item
6905Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6906and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6907integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6908and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6909@end itemize
6910
c906108c 6911@menu
5d161b24
DB
6912* C plus plus expressions::
6913* C Defaults::
6914* C Checks::
c906108c 6915
5d161b24 6916* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
6917@end menu
6918
6d2ebf8b 6919@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
6920@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
6921
6922@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
6923@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
6924
6925@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
6926@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
6927@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
6928@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
6929@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
6930@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
6931@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
6932@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
6933@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6934@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6935@c periodically whether this has happened...
6936@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
6937@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
6938proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
6939additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6940special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6941@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6942symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6943you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6944extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 6945@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6946support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6947@end quotation
c906108c
SS
6948
6949@enumerate
6950
6951@cindex member functions
6952@item
6953Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6954
6955@example
6956count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6957@end example
6958
41afff9a 6959@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 6960@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6961@item
6962While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6963expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6964that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 6965pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 6966
c906108c 6967@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 6968@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 6969@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6970@item
6971You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 6972call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
6973perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6974calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6975in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6976default arguments.
6977
6978It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6979promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6980class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6981functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6982number of function arguments.
6983
6984Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6985@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 6986,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 6987
d4f3574e 6988You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
6989explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6990@smallexample
6991p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6992@end smallexample
d4f3574e 6993
c906108c 6994The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 6995see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 6996
c906108c
SS
6997@cindex reference declarations
6998@item
b37052ae
EZ
6999@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
7000them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
7001dereferenced.
7002
7003In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
7004reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
7005avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
7006The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
7007you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
7008
7009@item
b37052ae 7010@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
7011expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
7012one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7013necessary, for example in an expression like
7014@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 7015resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7016debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7017@end enumerate
7018
b37052ae 7019In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
7020calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7021objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7022invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 7023
6d2ebf8b 7024@node C Defaults
b37052ae 7025@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 7026
b37052ae 7027@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 7028
c906108c
SS
7029If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7030both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 7031C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 7032selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
7033
7034If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7035recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7036@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 7037these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
7038@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7039for further details.
7040
c906108c
SS
7041@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7042@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7043@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 7044
6d2ebf8b 7045@node C Checks
b37052ae 7046@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 7047
b37052ae 7048@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 7049
b37052ae 7050By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
7051is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7052considers two variables type equivalent if:
7053
7054@itemize @bullet
7055@item
7056The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7057enumerated tag.
7058
7059@item
7060The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7061declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7062
7063@ignore
7064@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7065@c FIXME--beers?
7066@item
7067The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7068declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
7069compilers.)
7070@end ignore
7071@end itemize
7072
7073Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
7074indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7075that is not itself an array.
c906108c 7076
6d2ebf8b 7077@node Debugging C
c906108c 7078@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
7079
7080The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7081the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
7082inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
7083appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
7084
7085The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7086with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
7087,Expressions}.
7088
c906108c 7089@menu
5d161b24 7090* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
7091@end menu
7092
6d2ebf8b 7093@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 7094@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7095
b37052ae 7096@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7097
b37052ae
EZ
7098Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7099designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
7100
7101@table @code
7102@cindex break in overloaded functions
7103@item @r{breakpoint menus}
7104When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7105@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7106you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7107
b37052ae 7108@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7109@item rbreak @var{regex}
7110Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7111breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7112classes.
7113@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7114
b37052ae 7115@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
7116@item catch throw
7117@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 7118Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
7119Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7120
7121@cindex inheritance
7122@item ptype @var{typename}
7123Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7124@var{typename}.
7125@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7126
b37052ae 7127@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
7128@item set print demangle
7129@itemx show print demangle
7130@itemx set print asm-demangle
7131@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
7132Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7133displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
7134@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7135
7136@item set print object
7137@itemx show print object
7138Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7139@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7140
7141@item set print vtbl
7142@itemx show print vtbl
7143Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7144@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 7145(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 7146ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
7147
7148@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 7149@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 7150@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 7151Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
7152is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
7153and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 7154using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 7155expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
7156message.
7157
7158@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 7159Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
7160overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7161chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
7162symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
7163overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7164searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
7165argument types.
c906108c
SS
7166
7167@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
7168You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 7169the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
7170@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
7171also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
7172available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
7173@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
7174@end table
c906108c 7175
6d2ebf8b 7176@node Modula-2
c906108c 7177@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 7178
d4f3574e 7179@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
7180
7181The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
7182output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
7183developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
7184attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
7185to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7186table.
7187
7188@cindex expressions in Modula-2
7189@menu
7190* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
7191* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
7192* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
7193* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
7194* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
7195* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
7196* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7197* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7198@end menu
7199
6d2ebf8b 7200@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
7201@subsubsection Operators
7202@cindex Modula-2 operators
7203
7204Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7205@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7206often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
7207following definitions hold:
7208
7209@itemize @bullet
7210
7211@item
7212@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
7213their subranges.
7214
7215@item
7216@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
7217
7218@item
7219@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
7220
7221@item
7222@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
7223@var{type}}.
7224
7225@item
7226@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
7227
7228@item
7229@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
7230
7231@item
7232@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
7233@end itemize
7234
7235@noindent
7236The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
7237increasing precedence:
7238
7239@table @code
7240@item ,
7241Function argument or array index separator.
7242
7243@item :=
7244Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
7245@var{value}.
7246
7247@item <@r{, }>
7248Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
7249types.
7250
7251@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 7252Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
7253on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
7254set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
7255
7256@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
7257Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
7258Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
7259available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
7260comment character.
7261
7262@item IN
7263Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
7264Same precedence as @code{<}.
7265
7266@item OR
7267Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7268
7269@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 7270Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
7271
7272@item @@
7273The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7274
7275@item +@r{, }-
7276Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
7277and difference on set types.
7278
7279@item *
7280Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
7281on set types.
7282
7283@item /
7284Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
7285types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
7286
7287@item DIV@r{, }MOD
7288Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
7289precedence as @code{*}.
7290
7291@item -
7292Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
7293
7294@item ^
7295Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
7296
7297@item NOT
7298Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
7299@code{^}.
7300
7301@item .
7302@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
7303precedence as @code{^}.
7304
7305@item []
7306Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
7307
7308@item ()
7309Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
7310as @code{^}.
7311
7312@item ::@r{, }.
7313@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
7314@end table
7315
7316@quotation
7317@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
7318treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
7319@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
7320@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
7321@end quotation
7322
7323@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
6d2ebf8b 7324@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c
SS
7325@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
7326
7327Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
7328In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
7329
7330@table @var
7331
7332@item a
7333represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
7334
7335@item c
7336represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
7337
7338@item i
7339represents a variable or constant of integral type.
7340
7341@item m
7342represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
7343same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
7344be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
7345
7346@item n
7347represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
7348
7349@item r
7350represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
7351
7352@item t
7353represents a type.
7354
7355@item v
7356represents a variable.
7357
7358@item x
7359represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
7360explanation of the function for details.
7361@end table
7362
7363All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
7364
7365@table @code
7366@item ABS(@var{n})
7367Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
7368
7369@item CAP(@var{c})
7370If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 7371equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
7372
7373@item CHR(@var{i})
7374Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7375
7376@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7377Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7378
7379@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
7380Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7381new value.
7382
7383@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7384Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
7385set.
7386
7387@item FLOAT(@var{i})
7388Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
7389
7390@item HIGH(@var{a})
7391Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
7392
7393@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7394Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7395
7396@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
7397Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7398new value.
7399
7400@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7401Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
7402there. Returns the new set.
7403
7404@item MAX(@var{t})
7405Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
7406
7407@item MIN(@var{t})
7408Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
7409
7410@item ODD(@var{i})
7411Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
7412
7413@item ORD(@var{x})
7414Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
7415value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
7416@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
7417integral, character and enumerated types.
7418
7419@item SIZE(@var{x})
7420Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
7421
7422@item TRUNC(@var{r})
7423Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
7424
7425@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
7426Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7427@end table
7428
7429@quotation
7430@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
7431@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
7432an error.
7433@end quotation
7434
7435@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 7436@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
7437@subsubsection Constants
7438
7439@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
7440ways:
7441
7442@itemize @bullet
7443
7444@item
7445Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
7446expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
7447rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
7448trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
7449
7450@item
7451Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
7452decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
7453then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
7454@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
7455digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
7456digits.
7457
7458@item
7459Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
7460like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 7461also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
7462followed by a @samp{C}.
7463
7464@item
7465String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
7466pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
7467Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 7468Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
7469sequences.
7470
7471@item
7472Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
7473
7474@item
7475Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
7476@code{FALSE}.
7477
7478@item
7479Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
7480
7481@item
7482Set constants are not yet supported.
7483@end itemize
7484
6d2ebf8b 7485@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
7486@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
7487@cindex Modula-2 defaults
7488
7489If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7490both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7491Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7492selected the working language.
7493
7494If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7495code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 7496working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
7497the language automatically}, for further details.
7498
6d2ebf8b 7499@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
7500@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
7501@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
7502
7503A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
7504This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
7505
7506@itemize @bullet
7507@item
7508Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
7509integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
7510debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
7511pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
7512through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
7513returned a pointer.)
7514
7515@item
7516C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
7517non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
7518escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
7519printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
7520
7521@item
7522The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
7523argument.
7524
7525@item
7526All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
7527@end itemize
7528
6d2ebf8b 7529@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
7530@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
7531@cindex Modula-2 checks
7532
7533@quotation
7534@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
7535range checking.
7536@end quotation
7537@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
7538
7539@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
7540
7541@itemize @bullet
7542@item
7543They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
7544@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
7545
7546@item
7547They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
7548@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
7549@end itemize
7550
7551As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
7552whose types are not equivalent is an error.
7553
7554Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7555index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
7556
6d2ebf8b 7557@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
7558@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7559@cindex scope
41afff9a 7560@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
7561@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
7562@ifinfo
41afff9a 7563@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7564@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
7565@end ifinfo
7566@iftex
41afff9a 7567@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7568@end iftex
7569
7570There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
7571(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
7572similar syntax:
7573
7574@example
7575
7576@var{module} . @var{id}
7577@var{scope} :: @var{id}
7578@end example
7579
7580@noindent
7581where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
7582@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
7583identifier within your program, except another module.
7584
7585Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
7586specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
7587found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
7588enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
7589
7590Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
7591the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
7592definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
7593an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
7594module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
7595@var{module}.
7596
6d2ebf8b 7597@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
7598@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7599
7600Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
7601Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 7602specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 7603@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 7604apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
7605analogue in Modula-2.
7606
7607The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 7608with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 7609intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 7610created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 7611address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 7612@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
7613
7614@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
7615In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
7616interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 7617
6d2ebf8b 7618@node Chill
cce74817
JM
7619@subsection Chill
7620
7621The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 7622from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
7623supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
7624likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7625table.
7626
d4f3574e
SS
7627@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
7628@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
7629This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
7630of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
7631
7632@menu
104c1213
JM
7633* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
7634* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 7635* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
5d161b24 7636* Chill type and range checks::
53a5351d 7637* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
7638@end menu
7639
6d2ebf8b 7640@node How modes are displayed
cce74817
JM
7641@subsubsection How modes are displayed
7642
7643The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 7644with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
7645slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
7646provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
7647
7648@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
7649@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
7650@table @code
7651@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
7652@itemize @bullet
7653@item
7654@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
7655UINT, LONG, ULONG},
7656@item
5d161b24 7657@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
cce74817 7658@item
5d161b24 7659@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
cce74817
JM
7660@item
7661@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
7662@smallexample
7663(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7664type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7665@end smallexample
7666If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
7667@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7668@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
7669@smallexample
7670@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
7671@end smallexample
7672where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
7673expression (e.g. set element names).
cce74817
JM
7674@end itemize
7675
7676@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
7677A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 7678the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
7679@smallexample
7680(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7681type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
7682@end smallexample
7683
7684@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
7685@itemize @bullet
7686@item
d4f3574e 7687@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
7688followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
7689@item
7690@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
7691@end itemize
7692
7693@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
7694The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
7695<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
7696list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
7697the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
7698all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
7699
7700@ignore
7701@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
7702The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
5d161b24 7703type, and is therefore not really of interest.
cce74817
JM
7704@end ignore
7705
5d161b24 7706@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7707@itemize @bullet
7708@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7709@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
7710@smallexample
7711@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
7712@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7713where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
7714@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7715@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
7716@smallexample
7717@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
7718@end smallexample
7719where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
cce74817
JM
7720@end itemize
7721
5d161b24 7722@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7723@itemize @bullet
7724@item
7725@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
7726@item
7727@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
7728@end itemize
7729
7730@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
7731Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
7732
7733@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
7734@itemize @bullet
7735@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7736@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
7737@smallexample
7738@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
7739@end smallexample
7740followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
7741mode
cce74817 7742@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7743@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
7744@smallexample
7745@code{BOOLS(<string
7746length>)}
7747@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7748@end itemize
7749
7750@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
7751The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
7752followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
7753@smallexample
7754(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
5d161b24
DB
7755type = ARRAY (1:42)
7756 ARRAY (1:20)
cce74817
JM
7757 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7758@end smallexample
7759
5d161b24 7760@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
cce74817 7761The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
7762list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
7763of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
7764OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
7765of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
7766checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
7767always displays all variant fields.
7768@smallexample
7769(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
7770type = STRUCT (
7771 as x,
7772 bs x,
7773 CASE bs OF
7774 (karli):
7775 cs a
7776 (ott):
7777 ds x
7778 ESAC
7779)
7780@end smallexample
7781@end table
7782
6d2ebf8b 7783@node Locations
cce74817
JM
7784@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
7785
7786A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7787
7788A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
7789the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
7790Chill programs. How values are specified
7791is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7792
7793The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7794display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 7795
cce74817
JM
7796@smallexample
7797set result := EXPR
7798@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
7799
7800@noindent
7801This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 7802is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
7803
7804Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7805value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 7806mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
7807represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
7808value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 7809operator @samp{->}.
cce74817 7810
6d2ebf8b
SS
7811Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7812@smallexample
7813@code{@{ PROC
cce74817 7814(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6d2ebf8b
SS
7815location>}
7816@end smallexample
7817@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7818specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7819the entry point.
cce74817
JM
7820
7821@ignore
7822Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7823fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7824the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
7825implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
7826na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7827<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
7828@code{__proc_copy}.
7829
7830Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7831the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7832like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7833mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7834
7835Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 7836...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 7837definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
7838of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7839structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7840braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 7841on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 7842memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 7843all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 7844@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
7845stuff ???)
7846@smallexample
7847(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7848[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7849@end smallexample
7850@end ignore
7851
7852Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7853(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
7854certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7855and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7856
7857A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
7858location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7859name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7860have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
7861checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 7862therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 7863
cce74817
JM
7864@smallexample
7865(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7866@end smallexample
7867
6d2ebf8b 7868@node Values and their Operations
cce74817
JM
7869@subsubsection Values and their Operations
7870
7871Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7872more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
7873data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7874such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 7875constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 7876when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
7877(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7878the values behind these locations.
7879
d4f3574e 7880This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
7881operations are legal to be used with such values.
7882
7883@table @code
7884@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
7885Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7886For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 7887chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
7888@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7889@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817 7890
5d161b24 7891@ignore
cce74817
JM
7892@itemize @bullet
7893@item
7894@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 7895programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
7896@item
7897@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7898@item
7899@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7900@code{'M'})
7901@item
7902@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e 7903mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
b37052ae 7904comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
cce74817 7905@item
d4f3574e 7906@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817 7907emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
5d161b24 7908procedure value or the empty instance value.
cce74817
JM
7909
7910@item
7911@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 7912enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
7913to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7914@item
7915@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7916programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7917@item
7918@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 7919(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
7920@end itemize
7921@end ignore
7922
7923@item Tuple Values
7924A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 7925name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
7926unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7927@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 7928
cce74817
JM
7929@itemize @bullet
7930@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7931@item @emph{Array Tuple}
7932@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7933Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 7934same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
7935@end itemize
7936
7937@item String Element Value
6d2ebf8b
SS
7938A string element value is specified by
7939@smallexample
7940@code{<string value>(<index>)}
7941@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7942where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
7943value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7944the string.
7945
7946@item String Slice Value
7947A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7948spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7949expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7950@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7951The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7952string.
7953
7954@item Array Element Values
7955An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7956delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7957
7958@item Array Slice Values
7959An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7960@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
7961@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7962arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
7963which is part of the specified array.
7964
7965@item Structure Field Values
7966A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
7967name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7968in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
7969corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7970
7971@item Procedure Call Value
7972The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7973procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7974expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 7975effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 7976
d4f3574e 7977Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 7978
6d2ebf8b
SS
7979Values of time mode locations appear as
7980@smallexample
7981@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
7982@end smallexample
7983
cce74817
JM
7984
7985@ignore
7986This is not implemented yet:
7987@item Built-in Value
7988@noindent
7989The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 7990
cce74817
JM
7991@table @code
7992@item @code{ADDR()}
7993@item @code{NUM()}
7994@item @code{PRED()}
7995@item @code{SUCC()}
7996@item @code{ABS()}
7997@item @code{CARD()}
7998@item @code{MAX()}
7999@item @code{MIN()}
8000@item @code{SIZE()}
8001@item @code{UPPER()}
8002@item @code{LOWER()}
8003@item @code{LENGTH()}
8004@item @code{SIN()}
8005@item @code{COS()}
8006@item @code{TAN()}
8007@item @code{ARCSIN()}
8008@item @code{ARCCOS()}
8009@item @code{ARCTAN()}
8010@item @code{EXP()}
8011@item @code{LN()}
8012@item @code{LOG()}
8013@item @code{SQRT()}
8014@end table
8015
8016For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8017chapter 1.6.
8018@end ignore
8019
8020@item Zero-adic Operator Value
8021The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8022current active process.
8023
8024@item Expression Values
8025The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 8026the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 8027incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 8028corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 8029causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 8030which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 8031operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 8032
cce74817
JM
8033@table @code
8034@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8035@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8036@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8037Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 8038
cce74817
JM
8039@item @code{=, /=}
8040Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 8041
cce74817 8042@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8043@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8044Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8045
cce74817 8046@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 8047@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 8048Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8049
cce74817
JM
8050@item @code{-}
8051Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 8052
cce74817
JM
8053@item @code{//}
8054String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 8055
cce74817
JM
8056@item @code{()}
8057String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 8058
cce74817
JM
8059@item @code{->}
8060Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8061address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8062location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 8063
cce74817 8064@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8065@itemx @code{AND}
8066@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8067Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 8068
cce74817 8069@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8070@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8071Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 8072
cce74817
JM
8073@item @code{IN}
8074Membership operator.
8075@end table
8076@end table
8077
6d2ebf8b 8078@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
8079@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8080
8081@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 8082of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 8083complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 8084equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
8085structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8086
8087Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8088index bounds and all built in procedures.
8089
8090Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 8091check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
8092operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8093functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8094language specification.
8095
cce74817
JM
8096All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8097off}.
8098
5d161b24 8099@ignore
53a5351d 8100@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
8101see last paragraph ?
8102@end ignore
8103
6d2ebf8b 8104@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
8105@subsubsection Chill defaults
8106
8107If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8108both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8109Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
8110selected the working language.
8111
8112If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8113code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 8114working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
8115the language automatically}, for further details.
8116
6d2ebf8b 8117@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8118@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8119
d4f3574e 8120The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8121symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8122program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8123does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8124program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8125(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8126file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8127
8128@cindex symbol names
8129@cindex names of symbols
8130@cindex quoting names
8131Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8132characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8133most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8134source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8135are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8136ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8137@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8138@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8139
8140@example
8141p 'foo.c'::x
8142@end example
8143
8144@noindent
8145looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8146
8147@table @code
8148@kindex info address
b37052ae 8149@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8150@item info address @var{symbol}
8151Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8152variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8153local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8154is always stored.
8155
8156Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8157at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8158the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8159
3d67e040 8160@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8161@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8162@item info symbol @var{addr}
8163Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8164If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8165nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8166
8167@example
8168(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8169_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8170@end example
8171
8172@noindent
8173This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8174it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8175
c906108c 8176@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8177@item whatis @var{expr}
8178Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8179actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8180assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8181@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8182
8183@item whatis
8184Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8185
8186@kindex ptype
8187@item ptype @var{typename}
8188Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8189the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8190@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8191@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8192
d4f3574e 8193@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8194@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8195Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8196differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8197of just the name of the type.
8198
8199For example, for this variable declaration:
8200
8201@example
8202struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8203@end example
8204
8205@noindent
8206the two commands give this output:
8207
8208@example
8209@group
8210(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8211type = struct complex
8212(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8213type = struct complex @{
8214 double real;
8215 double imag;
8216@}
8217@end group
8218@end example
8219
8220@noindent
8221As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8222the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8223
8224@kindex info types
8225@item info types @var{regexp}
8226@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8227Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8228(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8229complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8230@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8231names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8232information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8233
8234This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8235@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8236lists all source files where a type is defined.
8237
b37052ae
EZ
8238@kindex info scope
8239@cindex local variables
8240@item info scope @var{addr}
8241List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8242accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8243preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8244scope defined by that location. For example:
8245
8246@smallexample
8247(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8248Scope for command_line_handler:
8249Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8250Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8251Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8252Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8253Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8254Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8255Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8256@end smallexample
8257
f5c37c66
EZ
8258@noindent
8259This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8260during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8261collect}.
8262
c906108c
SS
8263@kindex info source
8264@item info source
8265Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
8266the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
8267it was written in.
8268
8269@kindex info sources
8270@item info sources
8271Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8272debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8273have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8274
8275@kindex info functions
8276@item info functions
8277Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8278
8279@item info functions @var{regexp}
8280Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8281whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8282Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8283include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
8284start with @code{step}.
8285
8286@kindex info variables
8287@item info variables
8288Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
8289outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
8290
8291@item info variables @var{regexp}
8292Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8293variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8294@var{regexp}.
8295
8296@ignore
8297This was never implemented.
8298@kindex info methods
8299@item info methods
8300@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8301The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8302methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8303specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8304C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8305from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8306@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8307which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8308@end ignore
8309
c906108c
SS
8310@cindex reloading symbols
8311Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8312be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8313in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8314running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8315@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8316
8317@table @code
8318@kindex set symbol-reloading
8319@item set symbol-reloading on
8320Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8321object file with a particular name is seen again.
8322
8323@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8324Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8325same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8326running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8327should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8328may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8329several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8330name.
c906108c
SS
8331
8332@kindex show symbol-reloading
8333@item show symbol-reloading
8334Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8335@end table
c906108c 8336
c906108c
SS
8337@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8338@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8339Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8340declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8341@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8342source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8343another source file. The default is on.
8344
8345A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8346the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8347
8348@item set opaque-type-resolution off
8349Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8350is printed as follows:
8351@smallexample
8352@{<no data fields>@}
8353@end smallexample
8354
8355@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8356@item show opaque-type-resolution
8357Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
8358
8359@kindex maint print symbols
8360@cindex symbol dump
8361@kindex maint print psymbols
8362@cindex partial symbol dump
8363@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8364@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8365@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8366Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8367These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8368symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8369symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
8370collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
8371only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
8372command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
8373use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
8374symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
8375files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
8376@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
8377required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
8378@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
8379@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
8380@end table
8381
6d2ebf8b 8382@node Altering
c906108c
SS
8383@chapter Altering Execution
8384
8385Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
8386find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
8387correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
8388experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
8389program.
8390
8391For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
8392locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
8393address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
8394
8395@menu
8396* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
8397* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 8398* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
8399* Returning:: Returning from a function
8400* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
8401* Patching:: Patching your program
8402@end menu
8403
6d2ebf8b 8404@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
8405@section Assignment to variables
8406
8407@cindex assignment
8408@cindex setting variables
8409To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
8410@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
8411
8412@example
8413print x=4
8414@end example
8415
8416@noindent
8417stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 8418value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
8419@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
8420information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
8421
8422@kindex set variable
8423@cindex variables, setting
8424If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
8425@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
8426really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
8427not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
8428,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
8429
c906108c
SS
8430If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
8431appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
8432variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
8433to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
8434program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
8435a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
8436command @code{set width}:
8437
8438@example
8439(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
8440type = double
8441(@value{GDBP}) p width
8442$4 = 13
8443(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
8444Invalid syntax in expression.
8445@end example
8446
8447@noindent
8448The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
8449order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
8450
8451@example
8452(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
8453@end example
53a5351d 8454
c906108c
SS
8455Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
8456with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
8457@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
8458your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
8459to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
8460the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
8461
8462@example
8463@group
8464(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
8465type = double
8466(@value{GDBP}) p g
8467$1 = 1
8468(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 8469(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
8470$2 = 1
8471(@value{GDBP}) r
8472The program being debugged has been started already.
8473Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
8474Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
8475"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
8476 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
8477(@value{GDBP}) show g
8478The current BFD target is "=4".
8479@end group
8480@end example
8481
8482@noindent
8483The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
8484@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
8485@code{g}, use
8486
8487@example
8488(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
8489@end example
c906108c
SS
8490
8491@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
8492freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
8493and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
8494same length or shorter.
8495@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
8496@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
8497
8498To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
8499construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
8500(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
8501to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
8502and representation in memory), and
8503
8504@example
8505set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
8506@end example
8507
8508@noindent
8509stores the value 4 into that memory location.
8510
6d2ebf8b 8511@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
8512@section Continuing at a different address
8513
8514Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
8515it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
8516an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
8517
8518@table @code
8519@kindex jump
8520@item jump @var{linespec}
8521Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
8522immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
8523source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
8524@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
8525in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
8526breakpoints}.
8527
8528The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
8529the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
8530register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
8531a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
8532be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
8533of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
8534confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
8535executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
8536well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
8537
8538@item jump *@var{address}
8539Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
8540@end table
8541
c906108c 8542@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
8543On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
8544command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
8545difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
8546changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
8547example,
c906108c
SS
8548
8549@example
8550set $pc = 0x485
8551@end example
8552
8553@noindent
8554makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
8555address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
8556@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
8557
8558The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
8559up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
8560that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
8561detail.
8562
c906108c 8563@c @group
6d2ebf8b 8564@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
8565@section Giving your program a signal
8566
8567@table @code
8568@kindex signal
8569@item signal @var{signal}
8570Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
8571signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
8572signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
8573SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
8574
8575Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
8576giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
8577a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
8578@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
8579signal.
8580
8581@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
8582after executing the command.
8583@end table
8584@c @end group
8585
8586Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
8587@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
8588causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
8589the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
8590passes the signal directly to your program.
8591
c906108c 8592
6d2ebf8b 8593@node Returning
c906108c
SS
8594@section Returning from a function
8595
8596@table @code
8597@cindex returning from a function
8598@kindex return
8599@item return
8600@itemx return @var{expression}
8601You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
8602command. If you give an
8603@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
8604value.
8605@end table
8606
8607When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
8608(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
8609discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
8610be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
8611
8612This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
8613frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
8614innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
8615specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
8616of functions.
8617
8618The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
8619program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
8620returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
8621and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
8622selected stack frame returns naturally.
8623
6d2ebf8b 8624@node Calling
c906108c
SS
8625@section Calling program functions
8626
8627@cindex calling functions
8628@kindex call
8629@table @code
8630@item call @var{expr}
8631Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
8632returned values.
8633@end table
8634
8635You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
8636execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
8637with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
8638is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 8639
c906108c
SS
8640For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
8641specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
8642calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
8643method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
8644that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 8645
6d2ebf8b 8646@node Patching
c906108c 8647@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 8648
c906108c
SS
8649@cindex patching binaries
8650@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 8651@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 8652
7a292a7a
SS
8653By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
8654executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
8655alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
8656patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
8657
8658If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
8659explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
8660want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
8661repairs.
8662
8663@table @code
8664@kindex set write
8665@item set write on
8666@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
8667If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
8668core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
8669off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
8670
8671If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
8672@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
8673write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
8674
8675@item show write
8676@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
8677Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
8678as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
8679@end table
8680
6d2ebf8b 8681@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
8682@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
8683
7a292a7a
SS
8684@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
8685both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
8686program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
8687@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
8688
8689@menu
8690* Files:: Commands to specify files
8691* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
8692@end menu
8693
6d2ebf8b 8694@node Files
c906108c 8695@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 8696
7a292a7a 8697@cindex symbol table
c906108c 8698@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
8699
8700You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
8701way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
8702@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
8703Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
8704
8705Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
8706@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
8707a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
8708to specify new files are useful.
8709
8710@table @code
8711@cindex executable file
8712@kindex file
8713@item file @var{filename}
8714Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
8715symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
8716executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
8717directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
8718@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
8719directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
8720to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8721and your program, using the @code{path} command.
8722
6d2ebf8b 8723On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
8724@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
8725@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
8726@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
8727descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
8728(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 8729@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 8730for more information.
c906108c
SS
8731
8732@item file
8733@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
8734has on both executable file and the symbol table.
8735
8736@kindex exec-file
8737@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8738Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
8739in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
8740if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
8741discard information on the executable file.
8742
8743@kindex symbol-file
8744@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8745Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
8746searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
8747table and program to run from the same file.
8748
8749@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
8750program's symbol table.
8751
5d161b24 8752The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
8753of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
8754auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
8755the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
8756the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
8757
8758@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
8759executing it once.
8760
8761When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
8762understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
8763generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
8764other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
8765Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
8766using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
8767optimized code.
c906108c
SS
8768
8769For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
8770using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
8771symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
8772quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
8773details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
8774
8775The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
8776start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
8777occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
8778file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
8779pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
8780warnings and messages}.)
8781
c906108c
SS
8782We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
8783symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
8784symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
8785still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
8786in stabs format.
8787
8788@kindex readnow
8789@cindex reading symbols immediately
8790@cindex symbols, reading immediately
8791@kindex mapped
8792@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
8793@cindex saving symbol table
8794@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8795@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8796You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
8797tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
8798load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 8799entire symbol table available.
c906108c 8800
c906108c
SS
8801If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
8802@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
8803cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
8804file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
8805from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
8806than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
8807program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
8808starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
8809
8810You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
8811file has all the symbol information for your program.
8812
8813The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
8814@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
8815than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
8816it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
8817needed.
8818
8819The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
8820@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
8821symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
8822
8823@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
8824@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
8825@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
8826@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
8827@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
8828@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8829@c files.
8830
8831@kindex core
8832@kindex core-file
8833@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8834Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8835of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8836address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8837executable file itself for other parts.
8838
8839@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8840to be used.
8841
8842Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
8843under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
8844wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8845the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 8846(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 8847
c906108c
SS
8848@kindex add-symbol-file
8849@cindex dynamic linking
8850@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8851@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
d167840f 8852@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}
96a2c332
SS
8853The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8854information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
8855when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8856into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
8857address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
8858this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
8859of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
8860section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
8861@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
8862
8863The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8864originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
8865@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8866thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
8867instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c
SS
8868
8869@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8870
8871You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8872the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8873table information for @var{filename}.
8874
8875@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8876@item add-shared-symbol-file
8877The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
8878operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8879shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 8880@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 8881
c906108c
SS
8882@kindex section
8883@item section
5d161b24
DB
8884The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8885the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8886section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8887specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
8888separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8889the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
8890
8891@kindex info files
8892@kindex info target
8893@item info files
8894@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
8895@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8896current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8897including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8898use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
8899command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8900current ones.
8901
c906108c
SS
8902@end table
8903
8904All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8905as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8906name and remembers it that way.
8907
c906108c 8908@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
8909@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8910libraries.
53a5351d 8911
c906108c
SS
8912@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8913when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8914(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8915references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8916debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
8917
8918On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8919automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8920
c906108c
SS
8921@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8922@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8923@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8924
8925@table @code
8926@kindex info sharedlibrary
8927@kindex info share
8928@item info share
8929@itemx info sharedlibrary
8930Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
8931
8932@kindex sharedlibrary
8933@kindex share
8934@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
8935@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
8936Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
8937Unix regular expression.
8938As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
8939required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
8940@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
8941loaded.
8942@end table
8943
53a5351d
JM
8944On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8945and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8946a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
c906108c
SS
8947
8948Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
8949loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8950@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
8951automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8952
8953To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8954
8955@table @code
8956@kindex set auto-solib-add
8957@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8958Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
8959nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8960automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8961linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8962the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8963Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8964@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8965
8966@kindex show auto-solib-add
8967@item show auto-solib-add
8968Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8969@end table
c906108c 8970
6d2ebf8b 8971@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
8972@section Errors reading symbol files
8973
8974While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8975such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8976output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8977they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8978debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
8979about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8980only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8981times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8982to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8983complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8984messages}).
8985
8986The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8987
8988@table @code
8989@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8990
8991The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8992(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
8993error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8994in its outer scope blocks.
8995
8996@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
8997the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
8998may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
8999function.
9000
9001@item block at @var{address} out of order
9002
9003The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9004order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9005do so.
9006
9007@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9008locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9009can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9010@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9011messages}.)
9012
9013@item bad block start address patched
9014
9015The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9016smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9017to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9018
9019@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9020starting on the previous source line.
9021
9022@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9023
9024@cindex foo
9025Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9026larger than the size of the string table.
9027
9028@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9029name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9030with this name.
9031
9032@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9033
7a292a7a
SS
9034The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9035not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 9036uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 9037
7a292a7a
SS
9038@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9039This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 9040are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
9041debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9042on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9043and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
9044
9045@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 9046
7a292a7a 9047@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 9048
7a292a7a 9049@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 9050The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
9051information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9052it.
c906108c
SS
9053
9054@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9055
9056@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 9057
c906108c
SS
9058@end table
9059
6d2ebf8b 9060@node Targets
c906108c 9061@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 9062
c906108c
SS
9063@cindex debugging target
9064@kindex target
9065
9066A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
9067
9068Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9069in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9070you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
9071flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9072host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
9073realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9074command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9075(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
9076
9077@menu
9078* Active Targets:: Active targets
9079* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
9080* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9081* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 9082* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
9083
9084@end menu
9085
6d2ebf8b 9086@node Active Targets
c906108c 9087@section Active targets
7a292a7a 9088
c906108c
SS
9089@cindex stacking targets
9090@cindex active targets
9091@cindex multiple targets
9092
c906108c 9093There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
9094executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9095active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9096start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9097a core file.
c906108c
SS
9098
9099For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9100@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9101well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9102@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9103first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9104requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9105are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9106read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9107executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
9108
9109When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
9110target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9111commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9112an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9113process target is active.
c906108c 9114
7a292a7a
SS
9115Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9116core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 9117files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
9118the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9119process}).
c906108c 9120
6d2ebf8b 9121@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
9122@section Commands for managing targets
9123
9124@table @code
9125@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
9126Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9127process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9128facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9129protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
9130
9131Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9132typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9133with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
9134
9135The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9136after executing the command.
9137
9138@kindex help target
9139@item help target
9140Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9141currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9142(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9143
9144@item help target @var{name}
9145Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9146select it.
9147
9148@kindex set gnutarget
9149@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 9150@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 9151knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
9152a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9153with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
9154with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9155
d4f3574e 9156@quotation
c906108c
SS
9157@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9158you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 9159@end quotation
c906108c 9160
d4f3574e
SS
9161@noindent
9162@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 9163
5d161b24 9164@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
9165@item show gnutarget
9166Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9167@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9168@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9169and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9170@end table
9171
c906108c
SS
9172Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9173configuration):
c906108c
SS
9174
9175@table @code
9176@kindex target exec
9177@item target exec @var{program}
9178An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9179@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9180
c906108c
SS
9181@kindex target core
9182@item target core @var{filename}
9183A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9184@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
9185
9186@kindex target remote
9187@item target remote @var{dev}
9188Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9189specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9190@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9191supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
9192some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9193it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9194
c906108c
SS
9195@kindex target sim
9196@item target sim
2df3850c 9197Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
9198In general,
9199@example
9200 target sim
9201 load
9202 run
9203@end example
d4f3574e 9204@noindent
104c1213 9205works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 9206drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
9207provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9208see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9209Processors}.
9210
c906108c
SS
9211@end table
9212
104c1213 9213Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
9214
9215@table @code
9216
c906108c
SS
9217@kindex target nrom
9218@item target nrom @var{dev}
9219NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9220
c906108c
SS
9221@end table
9222
5d161b24 9223Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 9224your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
9225
9226Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9227once you've successfully established a connection.
9228
9229@table @code
9230
9231@kindex load @var{filename}
9232@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
9233Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9234@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9235is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9236on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9237@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9238the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9239
9240If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9241execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9242target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
9243
9244The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9245For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9246link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9247specifies a fixed address.
9248@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9249
c906108c
SS
9250@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9251@end table
9252
6d2ebf8b 9253@node Byte Order
c906108c 9254@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 9255
c906108c
SS
9256@cindex choosing target byte order
9257@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
9258
9259Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
9260offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
9261orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
9262designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
9263which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 9264@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
9265
9266@table @code
9267@kindex set endian big
9268@item set endian big
9269Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
9270
9271@kindex set endian little
9272@item set endian little
9273Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
9274
9275@kindex set endian auto
9276@item set endian auto
9277Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
9278executable.
9279
9280@item show endian
9281Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
9282
9283@end table
9284
9285Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
9286data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
9287target system.
9288
6d2ebf8b 9289@node Remote
c906108c
SS
9290@section Remote debugging
9291@cindex remote debugging
9292
9293If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
9294@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
9295For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
9296or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
9297powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
9298
9299Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
9300to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 9301@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
9302but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
9303write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
9304communicate with @value{GDBN}.
9305
9306Other remote targets may be available in your
9307configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 9308
c906108c 9309@menu
c906108c 9310* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
9311@end menu
9312
6d2ebf8b 9313@node Remote Serial
104c1213 9314@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 9315
104c1213
JM
9316@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
9317To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
9318@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
9319prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
9320program, you need:
c906108c 9321
104c1213
JM
9322@enumerate
9323@item
9324A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
9325have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
9326your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 9327
5d161b24 9328@item
d4f3574e 9329A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 9330subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 9331
104c1213
JM
9332@item
9333A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
9334download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
9335manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
9336documentation.
9337@end enumerate
96baa820 9338
104c1213
JM
9339The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
9340communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
9341machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 9342
104c1213
JM
9343@table @emph
9344@item On the host,
9345@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
9346else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
9347(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
9348
9349@item On the target,
9350you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
9351implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
9352subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
9353
9354On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
9355@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
9356@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
9357@end table
96baa820 9358
104c1213
JM
9359The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
9360machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
9361@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 9362
104c1213
JM
9363@cindex remote serial stub list
9364These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 9365
104c1213
JM
9366@table @code
9367
9368@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 9369@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9370@cindex Intel
9371@cindex i386
9372For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
9373
9374@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 9375@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9376@cindex Motorola 680x0
9377@cindex m680x0
9378For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
9379
9380@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 9381@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9382@cindex Hitachi
9383@cindex SH
9384For Hitachi SH architectures.
9385
9386@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 9387@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9388@cindex Sparc
9389For @sc{sparc} architectures.
9390
9391@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 9392@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9393@cindex Fujitsu
9394@cindex SparcLite
9395For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
9396
9397@end table
9398
9399The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
9400recently added stubs.
9401
9402@menu
9403* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
9404* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
9405* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
9406* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
9407* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
9408* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
9409@end menu
9410
6d2ebf8b 9411@node Stub Contents
104c1213
JM
9412@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
9413
9414@cindex remote serial stub
9415The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
9416subroutines:
9417
9418@table @code
9419@item set_debug_traps
9420@kindex set_debug_traps
9421@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
9422This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
9423program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
9424beginning of your program.
9425
9426@item handle_exception
9427@kindex handle_exception
9428@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
9429This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
9430explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
9431run when a trap is triggered.
9432
9433@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
9434execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
9435with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
9436protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 9437representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
9438information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
9439retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
9440execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
9441@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 9442machine.
104c1213
JM
9443
9444@item breakpoint
9445@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
9446Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
9447breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
9448way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
9449machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
9450pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
9451@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
9452simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
9453again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
9454your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 9455@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
9456
9457Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
9458to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
9459start of your debugging session.
9460@end table
9461
6d2ebf8b 9462@node Bootstrapping
104c1213
JM
9463@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
9464
9465@cindex remote stub, support routines
9466The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
9467chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
9468debugging target machine.
9469
9470First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
9471serial port.
9472
9473@table @code
9474@item int getDebugChar()
9475@kindex getDebugChar
9476Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
9477It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
9478different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9479
9480@item void putDebugChar(int)
9481@kindex putDebugChar
9482Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 9483It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
9484different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9485@end table
9486
9487@cindex control C, and remote debugging
9488@cindex interrupting remote targets
9489If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
9490running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
9491for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
9492character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
9493remote system to stop.
9494
9495Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
9496probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
9497is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
9498@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
9499
9500Other routines you need to supply are:
9501
9502@table @code
9503@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
9504@kindex exceptionHandler
9505Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
9506handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
9507way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
9508are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
9509containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
9510@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
9511its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
9512might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
9513exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
9514@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
9515and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
9516you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
9517should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
9518
9519For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
9520gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
9521should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
9522@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
9523help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
9524
9525@item void flush_i_cache()
9526@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 9527On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
9528instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
9529instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
9530
9531On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
9532function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
9533@end table
9534
9535@noindent
9536You must also make sure this library routine is available:
9537
9538@table @code
9539@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
9540@kindex memset
9541This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
9542memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
9543@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
9544either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
9545@end table
9546
9547If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
9548library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
9549but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 9550subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
9551
9552
6d2ebf8b 9553@node Debug Session
104c1213
JM
9554@subsubsection Putting it all together
9555
9556@cindex remote serial debugging summary
9557In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
9558steps.
9559
9560@enumerate
9561@item
6d2ebf8b 9562Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
9563(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
9564@display
9565@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
9566@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
9567@end display
9568
9569@item
9570Insert these lines near the top of your program:
9571
9572@example
9573set_debug_traps();
9574breakpoint();
9575@end example
9576
9577@item
9578For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
9579@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
9580
9581@example
9582void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
9583@end example
9584
d4f3574e 9585@noindent
104c1213 9586but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 9587function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
9588@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
9589error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
9590one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
9591
9592@item
9593Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
9594your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
9595
9596@item
9597Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
9598the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
9599
9600@item
9601@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
9602@c document that. FIXME.
9603Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
9604whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
9605
9606@item
9607To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
9608as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
9609This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
9610of its pure text.
9611
d4f3574e 9612@item
104c1213 9613@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9614Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
9615Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
9616machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9617TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
9618to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
9619device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
9620
9621@example
9622target remote /dev/ttyb
9623@end example
9624
9625@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
9626To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9627@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
9628terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
9629
9630@example
9631target remote manyfarms:2828
9632@end example
9633@end enumerate
9634
9635Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
9636step and continue the remote program.
9637
9638To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
9639command.
9640
9641@cindex interrupting remote programs
9642@cindex remote programs, interrupting
9643Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
9644interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
9645program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
9646and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
9647interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
9648
9649@example
9650Interrupted while waiting for the program.
9651Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
9652@end example
9653
9654If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
9655(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
9656remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
9657goes back to waiting.
9658
6d2ebf8b 9659@node Protocol
104c1213
JM
9660@subsubsection Communication protocol
9661
9662@cindex debugging stub, example
9663@cindex remote stub, example
9664@cindex stub example, remote debugging
9665The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
9666communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
9667@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
9668these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
9669implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
9670with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
9671organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
9672
9673However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
9674the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
9675target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
9676it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
9677
9678In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
9679transmitted and received data respectfully.
9680
9681@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
9682@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
9683@cindex remote serial protocol
6cf7e474
AC
9684All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
9685sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
9686@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
9687@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
104c1213
JM
9688
9689@example
9690@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9691@end example
9692@noindent
104c1213
JM
9693
9694@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
9695@noindent
9696The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
6cf7e474
AC
9697characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
9698eight bit unsigned checksum).
9699
9700Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
9701specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
9702
9703@example
9704@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9705@end example
104c1213
JM
9706
9707@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
9708@noindent
6cf7e474
AC
9709That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
9710has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
9711since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
104c1213 9712
6cf7e474 9713@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
104c1213
JM
9714When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
9715response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
9716the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
9717retransmission):
9718
9719@example
9720<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9721-> @code{+}
9722@end example
9723@noindent
104c1213
JM
9724
9725The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
9726debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
9727the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
9728when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
9729
9730@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
6cf7e474
AC
9731exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
9732exceptions).
9733
9734Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
9735@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
9736HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
9737
9738Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
9739@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
9740would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
104c1213
JM
9741
9742Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
c3f6f71d 9743means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
104c1213
JM
9744which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
9745@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
9746where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
9747characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
9748value greater than 126 should not be used.
9749
9750Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
9751loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
9752character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
9753
9754So:
9755@example
9756"@code{0* }"
9757@end example
9758@noindent
9759means the same as "0000".
9760
598ca718 9761The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
104c1213
JM
9762error number. That number is not well defined.
9763
9764For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
9765(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
9766protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 9767on that response.
104c1213 9768
f1251bdd
C
9769A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
9770@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
9771optional.
9772
104c1213
JM
9773Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
9774their corresponding response @var{data}:
598ca718 9775@page
104c1213
JM
9776@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
9777@item Packet
9778@tab Request
9779@tab Description
9780
f1251bdd 9781@item extended ops
104c1213
JM
9782@tab @code{!}
9783@tab
d4f3574e 9784Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky---only needs to be set once.
598ca718 9785The extended remote protocol supports the @samp{R} packet.
104c1213
JM
9786@item
9787@tab reply @samp{}
9788@tab
9789Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
9790unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
9791support protocol extensions.
9792
9793@item last signal
9794@tab @code{?}
9795@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9796Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
9797and continue.
9798@item
9799@tab reply
9800@tab see below
9801
104c1213
JM
9802
9803@item reserved
9804@tab @code{a}
5d161b24 9805@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9806
f1251bdd 9807@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9808@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
9809@tab
598ca718
EZ
9810@item
9811@tab
9812@tab
104c1213
JM
9813Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
9814specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 9815See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
9816@item
9817@tab reply @code{OK}
9818@item
9819@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9820
9821@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
9822@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
9823@tab
9824Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
9825transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
9826transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
9827acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
9828to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9829ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9830specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9831that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9832happened.}
9833
9834@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9835@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9836@tab
9837Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9838breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9839@samp{z} packets.}
9840
9841@item continue
9842@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9843@tab
9844@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9845current address.
9846@item
9847@tab reply
9848@tab see below
9849
f1251bdd 9850@item continue with signal
104c1213
JM
9851@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9852@tab
9853Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
9854@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9855@item
9856@tab reply
9857@tab see below
9858
598ca718 9859@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
9860@tab @code{d}
9861@tab
d4f3574e 9862toggle debug flag.
104c1213 9863
f1251bdd 9864@item detach
104c1213 9865@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 9866@tab
2df3850c
JM
9867Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
9868@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
9869@item
9870@tab reply @emph{no response}
9871@tab
598ca718 9872@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
104c1213
JM
9873
9874@item reserved
9875@tab @code{e}
5d161b24 9876@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9877
9878@item reserved
9879@tab @code{E}
5d161b24 9880@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9881
9882@item reserved
9883@tab @code{f}
5d161b24 9884@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9885
9886@item reserved
9887@tab @code{F}
5d161b24 9888@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9889
9890@item read registers
9891@tab @code{g}
9892@tab Read general registers.
9893@item
9894@tab reply @var{XX...}
9895@tab
9896Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
9897with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 9898each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 9899determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
9900@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
9901@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
9902@item
9903@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
9904@tab for an error.
9905
9906@item write regs
9907@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
9908@tab
9909See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
9910@item
9911@tab reply @code{OK}
9912@tab for success
9913@item
9914@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9915@tab for an error
9916
9917@item reserved
9918@tab @code{h}
5d161b24 9919@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9920
f1251bdd 9921@item set thread
104c1213
JM
9922@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
9923@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9924Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
9925@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
9926continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
9927thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
9928@item
9929@tab reply @code{OK}
9930@tab for success
9931@item
9932@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9933@tab for an error
9934
d4f3574e
SS
9935@c FIXME: JTC:
9936@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
5d161b24 9937@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
d4f3574e
SS
9938@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
9939@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
9940@c described. For example:
9941@c
9942@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9943@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
9944@c otherwise returns current registers.
9945@c
9946@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9947@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9948@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9949
f1251bdd 9950@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9951@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9952@tab
9953Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9954present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9955step starting at that address.
9956
f1251bdd 9957@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9958@tab @code{I}
9959@tab
9960See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9961
9962@item reserved
9963@tab @code{j}
9964@tab Reserved for future use
9965
9966@item reserved
9967@tab @code{J}
5d161b24 9968@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9969
f1251bdd 9970@item kill request
104c1213
JM
9971@tab @code{k}
9972@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9973FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9974thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
9975
9976@item reserved
9977@tab @code{l}
5d161b24 9978@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9979
9980@item reserved
9981@tab @code{L}
5d161b24 9982@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9983
9984@item read memory
9985@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9986@tab
9987Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 9988Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
9989using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9990transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9991@item
9992@tab reply @var{XX...}
9993@tab
d4f3574e 9994@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 9995to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
9996sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
9997@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9998@item
9999@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10000@tab @var{NN} is errno
10001
10002@item write mem
10003@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
10004@tab
10005Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
10006@var{XX...} is the data.
10007@item
10008@tab reply @code{OK}
10009@tab for success
10010@item
10011@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10012@tab
10013for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
10014written).
10015
10016@item reserved
10017@tab @code{n}
5d161b24 10018@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10019
10020@item reserved
10021@tab @code{N}
5d161b24 10022@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10023
10024@item reserved
10025@tab @code{o}
5d161b24 10026@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10027
10028@item reserved
10029@tab @code{O}
5d161b24 10030@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10031
10032@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
10033@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
10034@tab
10035See write register.
10036@item
10037@tab return @var{r....}
10038@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
10039
f1251bdd 10040@item write reg
104c1213
JM
10041@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
10042@tab
10043Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
10044digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
10045@item
10046@tab reply @code{OK}
10047@tab for success
10048@item
10049@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10050@tab for an error
10051
f1251bdd 10052@item general query
104c1213
JM
10053@tab @code{q}@var{query}
10054@tab
598ca718 10055Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
104c1213 10056have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
10057company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
10058optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
10059must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
10060@item
10061@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 10062@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
10063@item
10064@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10065@tab error reply
10066@item
10067@tab reply @samp{}
10068@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
10069
f1251bdd 10070@item general set
104c1213
JM
10071@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
10072@tab
10073Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
10074naming conventions.
10075
598ca718 10076@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
d4f3574e
SS
10077@tab @code{r}
10078@tab
10079Reset the entire system.
104c1213 10080
f1251bdd 10081@item remote restart
104c1213
JM
10082@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
10083@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10084Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
10085definition. FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
10086packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
104c1213 10087
f1251bdd 10088@item step
104c1213
JM
10089@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
10090@tab
10091@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
10092same address.
10093@item
10094@tab reply
10095@tab see below
10096
f1251bdd 10097@item step with signal
104c1213
JM
10098@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
10099@tab
10100Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
10101@item
10102@tab reply
10103@tab see below
10104
f1251bdd 10105@item search
104c1213
JM
10106@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
10107@tab
10108Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
10109@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 10110bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213 10111
f1251bdd 10112@item thread alive
104c1213
JM
10113@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
10114@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
10115@item
10116@tab reply @code{OK}
10117@tab thread is still alive
10118@item
10119@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10120@tab thread is dead
5d161b24 10121
104c1213
JM
10122@item reserved
10123@tab @code{u}
5d161b24 10124@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10125
10126@item reserved
10127@tab @code{U}
5d161b24 10128@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10129
10130@item reserved
10131@tab @code{v}
5d161b24 10132@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10133
10134@item reserved
10135@tab @code{V}
5d161b24 10136@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10137
10138@item reserved
10139@tab @code{w}
5d161b24 10140@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10141
10142@item reserved
10143@tab @code{W}
5d161b24 10144@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10145
10146@item reserved
10147@tab @code{x}
5d161b24 10148@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10149
f1251bdd 10150@item write mem (binary)
104c1213
JM
10151@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
10152@tab
10153@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
10154binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
10155escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
10156@item
10157@tab reply @code{OK}
10158@tab for success
10159@item
10160@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10161@tab for an error
10162
10163@item reserved
10164@tab @code{y}
5d161b24 10165@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10166
10167@item reserved
10168@tab @code{Y}
5d161b24 10169@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10170
f1251bdd 10171@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10172@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10173@tab
10174See @samp{Z}.
10175
f1251bdd 10176@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10177@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10178@tab
10179@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
10180breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
10181@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
10182bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
10183the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
10184@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
10185potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
6d2ebf8b 10186implemented in an idempotent way.
104c1213
JM
10187@item
10188@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10189@tab for an error
10190@item
10191@tab reply @code{OK}
10192@tab for success
10193@item
10194@tab @samp{}
10195@tab If not supported.
10196
10197@item reserved
10198@tab <other>
5d161b24 10199@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10200
10201@end multitable
10202
d4f3574e
SS
10203The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
10204receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
10205@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
10206when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
10207number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
10208conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
10209
10210@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
10211
10212@item @code{S}@var{AA}
10213@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
10214
10215@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
10216@tab
10217@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
10218(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
10219by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
10220thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 10221starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
10222@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
10223extend the protocol.
10224
10225@item @code{W}@var{AA}
10226@tab
10227The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
10228applicable for certains sorts of targets.
10229
10230@item @code{X}@var{AA}
10231@tab
10232The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
10233
6d2ebf8b 10234@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
104c1213 10235@tab
6d2ebf8b
SS
10236@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
10237@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
10238@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
10239this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
10240spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
10241debugger.}
104c1213
JM
10242
10243@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
10244@tab
c3f6f71d 10245@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
10246while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
10247for 'W', 'T', etc.
10248
10249@end multitable
10250
d4f3574e
SS
10251The following set and query packets have already been defined.
10252
10253@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
10254
10255@item current thread
10256@tab @code{q}@code{C}
10257@tab Return the current thread id.
10258@item
10259@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
10260@tab
10261Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
10262@item
10263@tab reply *
10264@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
10265
bba2971c
MS
10266@item all thread ids
10267@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10268@item
10269@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
d4f3574e 10270@tab
bba2971c
MS
10271Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
10272may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
10273works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
10274obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
5d161b24 10275be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
bba2971c 10276sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
d4f3574e 10277@item
bba2971c
MS
10278@tab
10279@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
d4f3574e 10280@item
5d161b24 10281@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
bba2971c
MS
10282@tab A single thread id
10283@item
00e4a2e4 10284@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
bba2971c
MS
10285@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
10286@item
10287@tab reply @code{l}
10288@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
10289@item
10290@tab
10291@tab
10292In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
10293or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
10294respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
10295@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
10296(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
10297
10298@item extra thread info
480ff1fb 10299@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
bba2971c
MS
10300@tab
10301@item
10302@tab
10303@tab
10304Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
10305Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
10306the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
10307thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
10308The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
5d161b24 10309Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
bba2971c
MS
10310"Blocked on Mutex".
10311@item
10312@tab reply @var{XX...}
10313@tab
10314Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
10315printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
10316attributes.
d4f3574e
SS
10317
10318@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
10319@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
10320@tab
2b628194
MS
10321@item
10322@tab
10323@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10324Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
10325digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
10326subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
10327number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
10328(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
10329returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
10330@item
bba2971c
MS
10331@tab
10332@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10333query (see above).
10334@item
d4f3574e
SS
10335@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
10336@tab
2b628194
MS
10337@item
10338@tab
10339@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10340Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
10341returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
10342and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
10343digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
10344a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
10345digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
10346
bba2971c
MS
10347@item compute CRC of memory block
10348@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10349@tab
10350@item
10351@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10352@tab An error (such as memory fault)
10353@item
10354@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
10355@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
10356
d4f3574e
SS
10357@item query sect offs
10358@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
10359@tab
10360Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
10361image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
10362response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
10363offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
10364@item
10365@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
10366
10367@item thread info request
10368@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
10369@tab
598ca718
EZ
10370@item
10371@tab
10372@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10373Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
10374encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
10375@item
10376@tab reply *
10377@tab
10378See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
10379
10380@item remote command
10381@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
10382@tab
598ca718
EZ
10383@item
10384@tab
10385@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10386@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
10387execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
10388Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
10389number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
10390packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
10391stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
10392@item
10393@tab reply @code{OK}
10394@tab
10395A command response with no output.
10396@item
10397@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
10398@tab
10399A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
10400@item
10401@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10402@tab
10403Indicate a badly formed request.
10404
10405@item
10406@tab reply @samp{}
10407@tab
10408When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
10409
0f1f2b0a
MS
10410@item symbol lookup
10411@tab @code{qSymbol::}
10412@tab
10413Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
10414requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
10415@item
10416@tab
10417@tab
10418@item
10419@tab reply @code{OK}
10420@tab
10421The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
10422@item
10423@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
10424@tab
10425The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
10426@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
10427@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
10428message, described below.
10429
10430@item symbol value
10431@tab @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
10432@tab
10433Set the value of SYM_NAME to SYM_VALUE.
10434@item
10435@tab
10436@tab
10437@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value
10438the target has previously requested.
10439@item
10440@tab
10441@tab
10442@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}.
10443If @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this
10444field will be empty.
10445@item
10446@tab reply @code{OK}
10447@tab
10448The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
10449@item
10450@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
10451@tab
10452The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
10453@value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols (if available),
10454until the target ceases to request them.
10455
d4f3574e
SS
10456@end multitable
10457
10458The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
10459In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
10460bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
10461space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
10462The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
10463least-significant.
10464
10465@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
10466
10467@item MIPS32
10468@tab
10469All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1047032 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
10471registers; fsr; fir; fp.
10472
10473@item MIPS64
10474@tab
10475All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
10476thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
10477as @code{MIPS32}.
10478
10479@end multitable
10480
104c1213
JM
10481Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
10482does not get any direct output:
10483
10484@example
10485<- @code{R00}
10486-> @code{+}
10487@emph{target restarts}
10488<- @code{?}
10489-> @code{+}
10490-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10491<- @code{+}
10492@end example
10493
10494Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
10495
10496@example
10497<- @code{G1445...}
10498-> @code{+}
10499<- @code{s}
10500-> @code{+}
10501@emph{time passes}
10502-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10503<- @code{+}
10504<- @code{g}
10505-> @code{+}
10506-> @code{1455...}
10507<- @code{+}
10508@end example
10509
6d2ebf8b 10510@node Server
104c1213
JM
10511@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10512
10513@kindex gdbserver
10514@cindex remote connection without stubs
10515@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10516allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10517@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10518
10519@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10520because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10521that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10522@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10523@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10524because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10525also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10526started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10527Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10528the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10529do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10530by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10531choice for debugging.
10532
10533@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10534or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10535protocol.
10536
10537@table @emph
10538@item On the target machine,
10539you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10540@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10541strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10542system does all the symbol handling.
10543
10544To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10545the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
10546syntax is:
10547
10548@smallexample
10549target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10550@end smallexample
10551
10552@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10553hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10554@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10555@file{/dev/com1}:
10556
10557@smallexample
10558target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10559@end smallexample
10560
10561@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10562with it.
10563
10564To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10565
10566@smallexample
10567target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10568@end smallexample
10569
10570The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10571specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10572TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10573expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10574(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10575you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10576TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10577reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10578conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 10579and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
10580@code{target remote} command.
10581
10582@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10583you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10584symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10585using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10586(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 10587running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
10588remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10589is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10590@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10591@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10592
10593@smallexample
10594(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10595@end smallexample
10596
10597@noindent
10598communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10599
10600@smallexample
10601(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10602@end smallexample
10603
10604@noindent
10605communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10606For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10607the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10608text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10609@samp{Connection refused}.
10610@end table
10611
6d2ebf8b 10612@node NetWare
104c1213
JM
10613@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10614
10615@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10616@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10617allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10618@code{target remote}.
10619
10620@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10621using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10622
10623@table @emph
10624@item On the target machine,
10625you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10626@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10627can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10628host system does all the symbol handling.
10629
10630To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10631@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10632program. The syntax is:
10633
5d161b24 10634@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10635load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10636 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10637@end smallexample
10638
10639@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10640the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 10641to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
10642
10643For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
5d161b24 10644communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 10645using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
10646
10647@smallexample
10648load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10649@end smallexample
10650
10651@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10652you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10653symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10654using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10655(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 10656running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
10657remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10658argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10659@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10660
10661@smallexample
10662(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10663@end smallexample
10664
10665@noindent
10666communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10667@end table
10668
6d2ebf8b 10669@node KOD
104c1213
JM
10670@section Kernel Object Display
10671
10672@cindex kernel object display
10673@cindex kernel object
10674@cindex KOD
10675
10676Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10677@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10678and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10679mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10680displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10681
10682Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10683@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10684
10685@example
2df3850c 10686(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
10687@end example
10688
10689If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10690about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10691which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10692after the operating system:
10693
10694@example
2df3850c 10695(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
10696List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10697Object Description
10698any Any and all objects
10699@end example
10700
10701Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10702by the kernel.
10703
10704There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
10705is supported other than to try it.
10706
10707
6d2ebf8b 10708@node Configurations
104c1213
JM
10709@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
10710
10711While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10712cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10713describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
10714
10715There are three major categories of configurations: native
10716configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10717operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10718different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10719are quite different from each other.
10720
10721@menu
10722* Native::
10723* Embedded OS::
10724* Embedded Processors::
10725* Architectures::
10726@end menu
10727
6d2ebf8b 10728@node Native
104c1213
JM
10729@section Native
10730
10731This section describes details specific to particular native
10732configurations.
10733
10734@menu
10735* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10736* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10737@end menu
10738
6d2ebf8b 10739@node HP-UX
104c1213
JM
10740@subsection HP-UX
10741
10742On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10743begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10744name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10745
6d2ebf8b 10746@node SVR4 Process Information
104c1213
JM
10747@subsection SVR4 process information
10748
10749@kindex /proc
10750@cindex process image
10751
10752Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10753used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10754subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10755this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10756several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10757@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10758@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10759and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
10760
10761@table @code
10762@kindex info proc
10763@item info proc
10764Summarize available information about the process.
10765
10766@kindex info proc mappings
10767@item info proc mappings
10768Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10769on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10770
10771@kindex info proc times
10772@item info proc times
10773Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10774its children.
10775
10776@kindex info proc id
10777@item info proc id
10778Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10779the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
10780
10781@kindex info proc status
10782@item info proc status
10783General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10784stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10785received.
10786
10787@item info proc all
10788Show all the above information about the process.
10789@end table
10790
6d2ebf8b 10791@node Embedded OS
104c1213
JM
10792@section Embedded Operating Systems
10793
10794This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10795embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10796architectures.
10797
10798@menu
10799* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10800@end menu
10801
10802@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10803various real-time operating systems.
10804
6d2ebf8b 10805@node VxWorks
104c1213
JM
10806@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10807
10808@cindex VxWorks
10809
10810@table @code
10811
10812@kindex target vxworks
10813@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10814A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10815is the target system's machine name or IP address.
10816
10817@end table
10818
10819On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
10820current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
10821
10822@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
10823VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
10824the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10825both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 10826@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 10827installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
96a2c332 10828@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
10829
10830@table @code
10831@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
10832@kindex vxworks-timeout
5d161b24
DB
10833All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
10834This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10835seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
10836your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
104c1213
JM
10837of a thin network line.
10838@end table
10839
10840The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
10841this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
10842procedures.
10843
10844@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
10845To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
10846to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
10847library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
10848VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
10849kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
10850source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
10851information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
10852manual.
10853@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
10854
10855Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
10856your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
96a2c332
SS
10857run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
10858@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213
JM
10859
10860@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10861
10862@example
10863(vxgdb)
10864@end example
10865
10866@menu
10867* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
10868* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
10869* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
10870@end menu
10871
6d2ebf8b 10872@node VxWorks Connection
104c1213
JM
10873@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
10874
10875The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10876network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
10877
10878@example
10879(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10880@end example
10881
10882@need 750
10883@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10884
10885@smallexample
5d161b24 10886Attaching remote machine across net...
104c1213
JM
10887Connected to tt.
10888@end smallexample
10889
10890@need 1000
10891@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10892loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
10893these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10894path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10895to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
10896
10897@example
10898prog.o: No such file or directory.
10899@end example
10900
10901When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10902the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10903command again.
10904
6d2ebf8b 10905@node VxWorks Download
104c1213
JM
10906@subsubsection VxWorks download
10907
10908@cindex download to VxWorks
10909If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10910object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10911@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10912incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10913command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10914to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10915table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10916the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10917filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10918Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10919to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10920the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
10921@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10922and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
10923program, type this on VxWorks:
10924
10925@example
10926-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10927@end example
d4f3574e
SS
10928
10929@noindent
104c1213
JM
10930Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10931
10932@example
5d161b24 10933(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
104c1213
JM
10934(vxgdb) load prog.o
10935@end example
10936
10937@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
10938
10939@smallexample
10940Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
10941@end smallexample
10942
10943You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
10944after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
10945this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
10946auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
10947history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 10948debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
10949table.)
10950
6d2ebf8b 10951@node VxWorks Attach
104c1213
JM
10952@subsubsection Running tasks
10953
10954@cindex running VxWorks tasks
10955You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
10956follows:
10957
10958@example
10959(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10960@end example
10961
10962@noindent
10963where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
10964or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
10965the time of attachment.
10966
6d2ebf8b 10967@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
10968@section Embedded Processors
10969
10970This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10971configurations.
10972
10973@menu
10974* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
10975* ARM:: ARM
10976* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
10977* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
10978* i960:: Intel i960
10979* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
10980* M68K:: Motorola M68K
10981* M88K:: Motorola M88K
10982* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
10983* PA:: HP PA Embedded
10984* PowerPC: PowerPC
10985* SH:: Hitachi SH
10986* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
10987* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
10988* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
10989* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
10990@end menu
10991
6d2ebf8b 10992@node A29K Embedded
104c1213
JM
10993@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
10994
10995@menu
10996* A29K UDI::
10997* A29K EB29K::
10998* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
10999* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
11000* Remote Log:: Remote log
11001@end menu
11002
11003@table @code
11004
11005@kindex target adapt
11006@item target adapt @var{dev}
11007Adapt monitor for A29K.
11008
11009@kindex target amd-eb
11010@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
11011@cindex AMD EB29K
11012Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
11013@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
11014@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
11015name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
11016@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
11017
11018@end table
11019
6d2ebf8b 11020@node A29K UDI
104c1213
JM
11021@subsubsection A29K UDI
11022
11023@cindex UDI
11024@cindex AMD29K via UDI
11025
11026@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
11027protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
11028configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
11029program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
11030use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
11031@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
11032
11033@table @code
11034@item target udi @var{keyword}
11035@kindex udi
11036Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
11037@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
11038This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
11039connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
11040working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
11041to its pathname.
11042@end table
11043
6d2ebf8b 11044@node A29K EB29K
104c1213
JM
11045@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
11046
11047@cindex EB29K board
11048@cindex running 29K programs
11049
11050AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
11051with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
11052term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
11053@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
11054must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
11055board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
11056assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
11057@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
11058
6d2ebf8b 11059@node Comms (EB29K)
104c1213
JM
11060@subsubsection Communications setup
11061
11062The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
11063in DOS on the PC:
11064
11065@example
11066C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
11067@end example
11068
11069@noindent
11070This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
11071bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
11072you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
11073end of the connection as well.
11074@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
5d161b24 11075@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11076@c
11077@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
11078@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
11079@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
11080@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
11081@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
11082
11083To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
11084the following at the DOS console:
11085
11086@example
11087C:\> CTTY com1
11088@end example
11089
11090@noindent
11091(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
11092the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
96a2c332 11093had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
104c1213
JM
11094
11095From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
11096@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
11097
11098@example
11099cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
11100@end example
11101
11102@noindent
11103The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
11104serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
11105may look something like the following:
11106
11107@example
11108tip -9600 /dev/ttya
11109@end example
11110
11111@noindent
11112Your system may require a different name where we show
11113@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
11114parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
11115@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
11116system table @file{/etc/remote}.
11117@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
11118@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
11119@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
11120@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
11121@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
11122@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
11123@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11124@c
11125@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
11126@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
11127@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
11128
11129@kindex EBMON
11130Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
11131directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
11132start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
11133with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
11134@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
11135@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
11136
11137@example
11138C:\> G:
11139
11140G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
11141
11142G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
11143Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
11144Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
11145Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
11146
11147Enter '?' or 'H' for help
11148
11149PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
11150I/O Base = 0x208
11151Memory Base = 0xd0000
11152
11153Data Memory Size = 2048KB
11154Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
11155Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
11156
11157PageSize = 0x400
11158Register Stack Size = 0x800
11159Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
11160
11161CPU PRL = 0x3
11162Am29027 Available = No
11163Byte Write Available = Yes
11164
11165# ~.
11166@end example
11167
11168Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
11169typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
11170running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
11171
11172For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
11173way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 11174system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
11175PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
11176something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
11177other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
11178from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
11179serial line.
11180
6d2ebf8b 11181@node gdb-EB29K
104c1213
JM
11182@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
11183
11184Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
11185program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
11186name of your 29K program:
11187
11188@example
11189cd /usr/joe/work29k
11190@value{GDBP} myfoo
11191@end example
11192
11193@need 500
11194Now you can use the @code{target} command:
11195
11196@example
11197target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
11198@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
11199@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
11200@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11201@end example
11202
11203@noindent
11204In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
11205@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
11206@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
11207In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
11208a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
11209the name on the Unix side.
11210
11211At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
11212to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
11213@code{run}.
11214
11215To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
11216command.
11217
11218To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
11219once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
11220@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
11221@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 11222Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
11223and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
11224
6d2ebf8b 11225@node Remote Log
104c1213 11226@subsubsection Remote log
41afff9a 11227@cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
104c1213
JM
11228@cindex log file for EB29K
11229
11230The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
11231current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
11232@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
11233of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
11234another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
11235unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
11236
6d2ebf8b 11237@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11238@subsection ARM
11239
11240@table @code
11241
11242@kindex target rdi
11243@item target rdi @var{dev}
11244ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11245use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11246monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
5d161b24 11247
104c1213
JM
11248@kindex target rdp
11249@item target rdp @var{dev}
11250ARM Demon monitor.
11251
11252@end table
11253
6d2ebf8b 11254@node H8/300
104c1213
JM
11255@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11256
11257@table @code
11258
d4f3574e 11259@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
11260@item target hms @var{dev}
11261A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11262Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11263line and the communications speed used.
11264
d4f3574e 11265@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
11266@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11267E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11268
d4f3574e
SS
11269@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11270@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213 11271@item target sh3 @var{dev}
96a2c332 11272@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
104c1213
JM
11273Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11274
11275@end table
11276
11277@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11278@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11279@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11280@cindex Hitachi SH download
11281When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11282board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11283board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11284@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11285
11286@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
5d161b24 11287Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
104c1213
JM
11288
11289@enumerate
11290@item
11291that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11292for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11293emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 11294the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
11295H8/300, or H8/500.)
11296
11297@item
11298what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11299serial device available on your host is the default).
11300
11301@item
11302what speed to use over the serial device.
11303@end enumerate
11304
11305@menu
11306* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11307* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11308* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11309@end menu
11310
6d2ebf8b 11311@node Hitachi Boards
104c1213
JM
11312@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11313
11314@c only for Unix hosts
11315@kindex device
11316@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 11317Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
104c1213
JM
11318need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11319first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11320hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11321
11322@kindex speed
11323@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 11324@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
104c1213 11325speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 11326hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
11327the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11328@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
11329
11330The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11331use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11332use a DOS host,
11333@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11334called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11335through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11336to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11337
11338The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11339program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11340sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11341the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11342
11343First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11344board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11345port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11346When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 11347debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
11348for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11349@code{COM2}.
11350
11351@example
11352C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11353C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11354
11355Resident portion of MODE loaded
11356
11357COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11358
11359@end example
11360
11361@quotation
11362@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11363@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11364disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11365your development board.
11366@end quotation
11367
d4f3574e 11368@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
11369Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11370connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
96a2c332 11371the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
104c1213
JM
11372you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11373commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11374cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11375download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11376the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11377(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11378executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11379@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11380itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11381
11382@smallexample
11383(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 11384@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 11385 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
104c1213 11386 the conditions.
5d161b24 11387There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 11388for details.
2df3850c
JM
11389@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11390(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 11391Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 11392(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
11393.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11394.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11395.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11396@end smallexample
11397
11398At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11399you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11400sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11401@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11402resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11403@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11404
11405Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11406available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11407you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11408
11409Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11410@itemize @bullet
11411@item
11412to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11413no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11414
11415@item
11416to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11417normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11418to detect program completion.
11419@end itemize
11420
11421In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11422development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11423
6d2ebf8b 11424@node Hitachi ICE
104c1213
JM
11425@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11426
d4f3574e 11427@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
11428You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11429Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11430e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11431
11432@table @code
11433@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11434Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11435@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11436@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11437(for example, @samp{9600}).
11438
11439@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11440If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11441specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11442@end table
11443
6d2ebf8b 11444@node Hitachi Special
104c1213
JM
11445@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11446
11447Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11448
11449@table @code
11450
11451@kindex set machine
11452@kindex show machine
11453@item set machine h8300
11454@itemx set machine h8300h
11455Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11456architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11457to check which variant is currently in effect.
11458
11459@end table
11460
6d2ebf8b 11461@node H8/500
104c1213
JM
11462@subsection H8/500
11463
11464@table @code
11465
11466@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11467@cindex memory models, H8/500
11468@item set memory @var{mod}
11469@itemx show memory
11470Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11471@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11472memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11473@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
11474
11475@end table
11476
6d2ebf8b 11477@node i960
104c1213
JM
11478@subsection Intel i960
11479
11480@table @code
11481
11482@kindex target mon960
11483@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11484MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
11485
f0ca3dce 11486@kindex target nindy
104c1213
JM
11487@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11488An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11489the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11490@file{/dev/ttya}.
11491
11492@end table
11493
11494@cindex Nindy
11495@cindex i960
11496@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11497@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11498tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11499
11500@itemize @bullet
11501@item
11502Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11503Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
11504
11505@item
11506By responding to a prompt on startup;
11507
11508@item
11509By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11510session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11511
104c1213
JM
11512@end itemize
11513
11514@cindex download to Nindy-960
11515With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11516downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11517@value{GDBN}.
11518
11519@menu
11520* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11521* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11522* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11523@end menu
11524
6d2ebf8b 11525@node Nindy Startup
104c1213
JM
11526@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11527
11528If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11529options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11530reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11531
11532@example
5d161b24 11533Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
104c1213
JM
11534@end example
11535
11536@noindent
11537Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11538identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11539simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11540with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11541use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11542
6d2ebf8b 11543@node Nindy Options
104c1213
JM
11544@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11545
11546These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11547Nindy-960 board attached:
11548
11549@table @code
11550@item -r @var{port}
11551Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11552to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11553configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11554@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11555device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11556suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11557
11558@item -O
11559(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11560the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11561This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11562target architecture.
11563
11564@quotation
11565@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11566connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11567fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11568attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11569this process with an interrupt.
11570@end quotation
11571
11572@item -brk
11573Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11574system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11575
11576@quotation
11577@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11578requires; it only works with a few boards.
11579@end quotation
11580@end table
11581
11582The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11583port.
11584
11585@c @group
6d2ebf8b 11586@node Nindy Reset
104c1213
JM
11587@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11588
11589@table @code
11590@item reset
11591@kindex reset
11592For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11593system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11594circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11595a break is detected.
11596@end table
11597@c @end group
11598
6d2ebf8b 11599@node M32R/D
104c1213
JM
11600@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11601
11602@table @code
11603
11604@kindex target m32r
11605@item target m32r @var{dev}
11606Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11607
11608@end table
11609
6d2ebf8b 11610@node M68K
104c1213
JM
11611@subsection M68k
11612
11613The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11614target command for the following ROM monitors.
11615
11616@table @code
11617
11618@kindex target abug
11619@item target abug @var{dev}
11620ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11621
11622@kindex target cpu32bug
11623@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11624CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11625
11626@kindex target dbug
11627@item target dbug @var{dev}
11628dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11629
11630@kindex target est
11631@item target est @var{dev}
11632EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11633
11634@kindex target rom68k
11635@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11636ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11637
11638@end table
11639
11640If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11641instead have only a single special target command:
11642
11643@table @code
11644
11645@kindex target es1800
11646@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11647ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11648
11649@end table
11650
11651[context?]
11652
11653@table @code
11654
11655@kindex target rombug
11656@item target rombug @var{dev}
11657ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11658
11659@end table
11660
6d2ebf8b 11661@node M88K
104c1213
JM
11662@subsection M88K
11663
11664@table @code
11665
11666@kindex target bug
11667@item target bug @var{dev}
11668BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
11669
11670@end table
11671
6d2ebf8b 11672@node MIPS Embedded
104c1213
JM
11673@subsection MIPS Embedded
11674
11675@cindex MIPS boards
11676@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11677MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11678you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
11679
11680@need 1000
11681Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
11682
11683@table @code
11684@item target mips @var{port}
11685@kindex target mips @var{port}
11686To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11687name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11688command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11689the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11690been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11691download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
11692
11693For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11694port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11695debugger:
11696
11697@example
11698host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
11699@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11700(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11701(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11702(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
11703@end example
11704
11705@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11706On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11707connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11708concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11709@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11710
11711@item target pmon @var{port}
11712@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11713PMON ROM monitor.
11714
11715@item target ddb @var{port}
11716@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11717NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
11718
11719@item target lsi @var{port}
11720@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11721LSI variant of PMON.
11722
11723@kindex target r3900
11724@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11725Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11726
11727@kindex target array
11728@item target array @var{dev}
11729Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11730
11731@end table
11732
11733
11734@noindent
11735@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11736
11737@table @code
11738@item set processor @var{args}
11739@itemx show processor
11740@kindex set processor @var{args}
11741@kindex show processor
11742Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11743processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
5d161b24 11744For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
96c405b3 11745to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
5d161b24 11746Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
104c1213 11747is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
5d161b24 11748@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213
JM
11749
11750@item set mipsfpu double
11751@itemx set mipsfpu single
11752@itemx set mipsfpu none
11753@itemx show mipsfpu
11754@kindex set mipsfpu
11755@kindex show mipsfpu
11756@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11757@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11758If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11759coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
96a2c332 11760need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
104c1213
JM
11761file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11762functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11763@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11764functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11765with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11766processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11767double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11768@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
11769
11770In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11771floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11772and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
11773
11774As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11775@samp{show mipsfpu}.
11776
11777@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11778@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
11779@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11780@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
11781@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11782@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11783@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11784@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11785You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11786by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11787@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11788to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11789at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
11790
11791@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11792@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11793@itemx show timeout
11794@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11795@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11796@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11797@kindex set timeout
11798@kindex show timeout
11799@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11800@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11801You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11802remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11803default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11804waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11805retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11806You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11807retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11808@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
11809
11810The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11811is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11812forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11813to run before stopping.
11814@end table
11815
6d2ebf8b 11816@node PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11817@subsection PowerPC
11818
11819@table @code
11820
11821@kindex target dink32
11822@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11823DINK32 ROM monitor.
11824
11825@kindex target ppcbug
11826@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11827@kindex target ppcbug1
11828@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11829PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
11830
11831@kindex target sds
11832@item target sds @var{dev}
11833SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11834
11835@end table
11836
6d2ebf8b 11837@node PA
104c1213
JM
11838@subsection HP PA Embedded
11839
11840@table @code
11841
11842@kindex target op50n
11843@item target op50n @var{dev}
11844OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11845
11846@kindex target w89k
11847@item target w89k @var{dev}
11848W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
11849
11850@end table
11851
6d2ebf8b 11852@node SH
104c1213
JM
11853@subsection Hitachi SH
11854
11855@table @code
11856
d4f3574e 11857@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
11858@item target hms @var{dev}
11859A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11860commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11861the communications speed used.
11862
d4f3574e 11863@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
11864@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11865E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
11866
d4f3574e
SS
11867@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11868@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
11869@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11870@item target sh3e @var{dev}
11871Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11872
11873@end table
11874
6d2ebf8b 11875@node Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11876@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11877
11878@cindex Sparclet
11879
5d161b24
DB
11880@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11881Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11882@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11883both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
5d161b24 11884@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11885
11886@table @code
f0ca3dce 11887@item remotetimeout @var{args}
104c1213 11888@kindex remotetimeout
5d161b24
DB
11889@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11890This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11891seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
11892@end table
11893
41afff9a 11894@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
5d161b24 11895When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
d4f3574e 11896information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
5d161b24 11897load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
d4f3574e 11898@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
11899
11900@example
11901sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11902@end example
11903
d4f3574e 11904You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
11905
11906@example
11907sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11908@end example
11909
41afff9a 11910@cindex running, on Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11911Once you have set
11912your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
5d161b24 11913run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
11914(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11915
11916@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11917
11918@example
11919(gdbslet)
11920@end example
11921
11922@menu
11923* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11924* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11925* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
5d161b24 11926* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
11927@end menu
11928
6d2ebf8b 11929@node Sparclet File
104c1213
JM
11930@subsubsection Setting file to debug
11931
11932The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11933
11934@example
11935(gdbslet) file prog
11936@end example
11937
11938@need 1000
11939@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11940@value{GDBN} locates
11941the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11942path.
11943If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11944files will be searched as well.
11945@value{GDBN} locates
11946the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11947path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11948If it fails
11949to find a file, it displays a message such as:
11950
11951@example
11952prog: No such file or directory.
11953@end example
11954
11955When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
5d161b24 11956the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
104c1213
JM
11957@code{target} command again.
11958
6d2ebf8b 11959@node Sparclet Connection
104c1213
JM
11960@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
11961
11962The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11963To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
11964
11965@example
11966(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11967Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
5d161b24 11968main () at ../prog.c:3
104c1213
JM
11969@end example
11970
11971@need 750
11972@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11973
d4f3574e 11974@example
104c1213 11975Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 11976@end example
104c1213 11977
6d2ebf8b 11978@node Sparclet Download
104c1213
JM
11979@subsubsection Sparclet download
11980
11981@cindex download to Sparclet
5d161b24 11982Once connected to the Sparclet target,
104c1213
JM
11983you can use the @value{GDBN}
11984@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11985The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11986command.
5d161b24 11987Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 11988address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
11989offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11990of each of the file's sections.
11991For instance, if the program
11992@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
11993and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11994
11995@example
11996(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
11997Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
11998@end example
11999
5d161b24
DB
12000If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12001to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
104c1213
JM
12002to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12003
6d2ebf8b 12004@node Sparclet Execution
104c1213
JM
12005@subsubsection Running and debugging
12006
12007@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12008You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
5d161b24 12009commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
12010manual for the list of commands.
12011
12012@example
12013(gdbslet) b main
12014Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
5d161b24 12015(gdbslet) run
104c1213
JM
12016Starting program: prog
12017Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
120183 char *symarg = 0;
12019(gdbslet) step
120204 char *execarg = "hello!";
5d161b24 12021(gdbslet)
104c1213
JM
12022@end example
12023
6d2ebf8b 12024@node Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12025@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12026
12027@table @code
12028
12029@kindex target sparclite
12030@item target sparclite @var{dev}
5d161b24
DB
12031Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12032You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12033For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
104c1213
JM
12034remote protocol.
12035
12036@end table
12037
6d2ebf8b 12038@node ST2000
104c1213
JM
12039@subsection Tandem ST2000
12040
2df3850c 12041@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
12042STDBUG protocol.
12043
12044To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12045manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12046
12047@example
12048target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12049@end example
12050
12051@noindent
12052to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12053the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12054ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12055connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12056concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12057
12058The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12059this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12060would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12061(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12062available on your host computer.
12063@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12064@c basically hearsay.
12065
12066@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12067These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12068environment:
12069
12070@table @code
12071@item st2000 @var{command}
12072@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12073@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12074@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12075Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12076manual for available commands.
12077
12078@item connect
12079@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12080Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12081you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12082sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12083@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12084@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12085@end table
12086
6d2ebf8b 12087@node Z8000
104c1213
JM
12088@subsection Zilog Z8000
12089
12090@cindex Z8000
12091@cindex simulator, Z8000
12092@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12093
12094When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12095a Z8000 simulator.
12096
12097For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12098unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12099segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12100appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12101
12102@table @code
12103@item target sim @var{args}
12104@kindex sim
d4f3574e 12105@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
12106Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12107options, specify them via @var{args}.
12108@end table
12109
12110@noindent
12111After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12112CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12113@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12114to run your program, and so on.
12115
d4f3574e
SS
12116As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12117(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12118additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12119
12120@table @code
12121
12122@item cycles
12123Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12124
12125@item insts
12126Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12127
12128@item time
12129Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12130
12131@end table
12132
12133You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12134conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12135conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12136simulated clock ticks.
12137
6d2ebf8b 12138@node Architectures
104c1213
JM
12139@section Architectures
12140
12141This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 12142all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
12143
12144@menu
12145* A29K::
12146* Alpha::
12147* MIPS::
12148@end menu
12149
6d2ebf8b 12150@node A29K
104c1213
JM
12151@subsection A29K
12152
12153@table @code
12154
12155@kindex set rstack_high_address
12156@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12157@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12158@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12159On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 12160@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
12161extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12162stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12163memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12164this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12165the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12166address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12167hexadecimal.
12168
12169@kindex show rstack_high_address
12170@item show rstack_high_address
12171Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12172processors.
12173
12174@end table
12175
6d2ebf8b 12176@node Alpha
104c1213
JM
12177@subsection Alpha
12178
12179See the following section.
12180
6d2ebf8b 12181@node MIPS
104c1213
JM
12182@subsection MIPS
12183
12184@cindex stack on Alpha
12185@cindex stack on MIPS
12186@cindex Alpha stack
12187@cindex MIPS stack
12188Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12189sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12190find the beginning of a function.
12191
12192@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12193To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12194@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12195you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12196commands:
12197
12198@table @code
00e4a2e4 12199@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
104c1213
JM
12200@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12201Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12202search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12203default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12204larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12205and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12206
12207@item show heuristic-fence-post
12208Display the current limit.
12209@end table
12210
12211@noindent
12212These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12213for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12214
12215
6d2ebf8b 12216@node Controlling GDB
c906108c
SS
12217@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12218
53a5351d
JM
12219You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12220@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 12221data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 12222described here.
c906108c
SS
12223
12224@menu
12225* Prompt:: Prompt
12226* Editing:: Command editing
12227* History:: Command history
12228* Screen Size:: Screen size
12229* Numbers:: Numbers
12230* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
5d161b24 12231* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
c906108c
SS
12232@end menu
12233
6d2ebf8b 12234@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
12235@section Prompt
12236
12237@cindex prompt
12238
12239@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12240called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12241can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12242instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
5d161b24 12243the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
c906108c
SS
12244which one you are talking to.
12245
d4f3574e 12246@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
12247prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12248or a prompt that does not.
12249
12250@table @code
12251@kindex set prompt
12252@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12253Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12254
12255@kindex show prompt
12256@item show prompt
12257Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12258@end table
12259
6d2ebf8b 12260@node Editing
c906108c
SS
12261@section Command editing
12262@cindex readline
12263@cindex command line editing
12264
12265@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12266@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12267command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12268or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12269substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12270debugging sessions.
12271
12272You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12273command @code{set}.
12274
12275@table @code
12276@kindex set editing
12277@cindex editing
12278@item set editing
12279@itemx set editing on
12280Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12281
12282@item set editing off
12283Disable command line editing.
12284
12285@kindex show editing
12286@item show editing
12287Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12288@end table
12289
6d2ebf8b 12290@node History
c906108c
SS
12291@section Command history
12292
12293@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12294debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12295happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12296history facility.
12297
12298@table @code
12299@cindex history substitution
12300@cindex history file
12301@kindex set history filename
12302@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12303@item set history filename @var{fname}
12304Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12305This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12306list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12307exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12308the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12309to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
12310@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12311is not set.
c906108c
SS
12312
12313@cindex history save
12314@kindex set history save
12315@item set history save
12316@itemx set history save on
12317Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12318@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12319
12320@item set history save off
12321Stop recording command history in a file.
12322
12323@cindex history size
12324@kindex set history size
12325@item set history size @var{size}
12326Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12327This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12328@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12329@end table
12330
12331@cindex history expansion
12332History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12333@ifset have-readline-appendices
12334@xref{Event Designators}.
12335@end ifset
12336
12337Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12338is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12339@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12340follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12341a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12342history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12343@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12344
12345The commands to control history expansion are:
12346
12347@table @code
12348@kindex set history expansion
12349@item set history expansion on
12350@itemx set history expansion
12351Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12352
12353@item set history expansion off
12354Disable history expansion.
12355
12356The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12357editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12358or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12359@ifset have-readline-appendices
12360@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12361@end ifset
12362
12363@c @group
12364@kindex show history
12365@item show history
12366@itemx show history filename
12367@itemx show history save
12368@itemx show history size
12369@itemx show history expansion
12370These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12371@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12372@c @end group
12373@end table
12374
12375@table @code
41afff9a 12376@kindex shows
c906108c
SS
12377@item show commands
12378Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12379
12380@item show commands @var{n}
12381Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12382
12383@item show commands +
12384Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12385@end table
12386
6d2ebf8b 12387@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
12388@section Screen size
12389@cindex size of screen
12390@cindex pauses in output
12391
12392Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12393information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12394@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12395output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12396to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12397determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12398printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12399rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12400
d4f3574e
SS
12401Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12402driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 12403together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 12404@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
12405you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12406width} commands:
12407
12408@table @code
12409@kindex set height
12410@kindex set width
12411@kindex show width
12412@kindex show height
12413@item set height @var{lpp}
12414@itemx show height
12415@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12416@itemx show width
12417These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12418a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12419commands display the current settings.
12420
5d161b24
DB
12421If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12422output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
c906108c
SS
12423file or to an editor buffer.
12424
12425Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12426from wrapping its output.
12427@end table
12428
6d2ebf8b 12429@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
12430@section Numbers
12431@cindex number representation
12432@cindex entering numbers
12433
2df3850c
JM
12434You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12435@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12436@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12437begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12438default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12439numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12440change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12441radix} command.
c906108c
SS
12442
12443@table @code
12444@kindex set input-radix
12445@item set input-radix @var{base}
12446Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12447for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12448specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12449example, any of
12450
12451@smallexample
12452set radix 012
12453set radix 10.
12454set radix 0xa
12455@end smallexample
12456
12457@noindent
12458sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12459leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12460
12461@kindex set output-radix
12462@item set output-radix @var{base}
12463Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12464for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12465specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12466
12467@kindex show input-radix
12468@item show input-radix
12469Display the current default base for numeric input.
12470
12471@kindex show output-radix
12472@item show output-radix
12473Display the current default base for numeric display.
12474@end table
12475
6d2ebf8b 12476@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
12477@section Optional warnings and messages
12478
2df3850c
JM
12479By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12480running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12481command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12482internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
12483
12484Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12485which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12486see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
12487
12488@table @code
12489@kindex set verbose
12490@item set verbose on
12491Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12492
12493@item set verbose off
12494Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12495
12496@kindex show verbose
12497@item show verbose
12498Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12499@end table
12500
2df3850c
JM
12501By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12502object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12503find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12504symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
12505
12506@table @code
2df3850c 12507
c906108c
SS
12508@kindex set complaints
12509@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
12510Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12511unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12512@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12513to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
12514
12515@kindex show complaints
12516@item show complaints
12517Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 12518
c906108c
SS
12519@end table
12520
12521By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12522lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12523you try to run a program which is already running:
12524
12525@example
12526(@value{GDBP}) run
12527The program being debugged has been started already.
12528Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
12529@end example
12530
12531If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12532commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
12533
12534@table @code
2df3850c 12535
c906108c
SS
12536@kindex set confirm
12537@cindex flinching
12538@cindex confirmation
12539@cindex stupid questions
12540@item set confirm off
12541Disables confirmation requests.
12542
12543@item set confirm on
12544Enables confirmation requests (the default).
12545
12546@kindex show confirm
12547@item show confirm
12548Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 12549
c906108c
SS
12550@end table
12551
6d2ebf8b 12552@node Debugging Output
5d161b24
DB
12553@section Optional messages about internal happenings
12554@table @code
12555@kindex set debug arch
12556@item set debug arch
12557Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12558@kindex show debug arch
12559@item show debug arch
12560Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12561@kindex set debug event
12562@item set debug event
12563Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12564default is off.
12565@kindex show debug event
12566@item show debug event
12567Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12568info.
12569@kindex set debug expression
12570@item set debug expression
12571Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12572default is off.
12573@kindex show debug expression
12574@item show debug expression
12575Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12576debugging info.
12577@kindex set debug overload
12578@item set debug overload
b37052ae 12579Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
5d161b24
DB
12580info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12581is off.
12582@kindex show debug overload
12583@item show debug overload
b37052ae 12584Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
5d161b24
DB
12585debugging info.
12586@kindex set debug remote
12587@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12588@cindex serial connections, debugging
12589@item set debug remote
12590Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12591the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12592@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12593@kindex show debug remote
12594@item show debug remote
12595Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12596@kindex set debug serial
12597@item set debug serial
12598Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12599default is off.
12600@kindex show debug serial
12601@item show debug serial
12602Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12603info.
12604@kindex set debug target
12605@item set debug target
12606Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12607includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12608default is off.
12609@kindex show debug target
12610@item show debug target
12611Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12612info.
12613@kindex set debug varobj
12614@item set debug varobj
12615Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12616info. The default is off.
12617@kindex show debug varobj
12618@item show debug varobj
12619Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12620debugging info.
12621@end table
12622
6d2ebf8b 12623@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
12624@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
12625
12626Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
12627command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12628commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12629files.
c906108c
SS
12630
12631@menu
12632* Define:: User-defined commands
12633* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12634* Command Files:: Command files
12635* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12636@end menu
12637
6d2ebf8b 12638@node Define
c906108c
SS
12639@section User-defined commands
12640
12641@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
12642A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12643which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12644@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12645separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12646via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
12647
12648@smallexample
12649define adder
12650 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12651@end smallexample
12652
d4f3574e
SS
12653@noindent
12654To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
12655
12656@smallexample
12657adder 1 2 3
12658@end smallexample
12659
d4f3574e
SS
12660@noindent
12661This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
5d161b24 12662its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
c906108c
SS
12663reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12664functions calls.
12665
12666@table @code
2df3850c 12667
c906108c
SS
12668@kindex define
12669@item define @var{commandname}
12670Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12671by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
12672
12673The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12674which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12675commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12676
12677@kindex if
12678@kindex else
12679@item if
12680Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12681It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12682only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12683There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12684by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12685was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12686
12687@kindex while
12688@item while
12689The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12690which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12691execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12692The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12693evaluates to true.
12694
12695@kindex document
12696@item document @var{commandname}
12697Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
5d161b24
DB
12698accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12699defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12700reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12701After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
c906108c
SS
12702@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
12703
12704You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12705documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12706does not change the documentation.
12707
12708@kindex help user-defined
12709@item help user-defined
12710List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12711(if any) for each.
12712
12713@kindex show user
12714@item show user
12715@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
12716Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12717not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 12718definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 12719
c906108c
SS
12720@end table
12721
12722When user-defined commands are executed, the
12723commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12724stops execution of the user-defined command.
12725
12726If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
5d161b24
DB
12727without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12728commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
c906108c
SS
12729messages when used in a user-defined command.
12730
6d2ebf8b 12731@node Hooks
c906108c 12732@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
12733@cindex command hooks
12734@cindex hooks, for commands
c78b4128 12735@cindex hooks, pre-command
c906108c 12736
c78b4128
EZ
12737@kindex hook
12738@kindex hook-
12739You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
c906108c
SS
12740command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12741command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12742before that command.
12743
c78b4128
EZ
12744@cindex hooks, post-command
12745@kindex hookpost
12746@kindex hookpost-
12747A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12748Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12749@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12750that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12751pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
12752
12753It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12754occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
12755
12756@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12757@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
12758
d4f3574e 12759@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
12760In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12761(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12762execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12763displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
12764
c906108c
SS
12765For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12766single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12767you could define:
12768
12769@example
12770define hook-stop
12771handle SIGALRM nopass
12772end
12773
12774define hook-run
12775handle SIGALRM pass
12776end
12777
12778define hook-continue
12779handle SIGLARM pass
12780end
12781@end example
c906108c 12782
c78b4128
EZ
12783As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12784command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12785you could define:
12786
12787@example
12788define hook-echo
12789echo <<<---
12790end
12791
12792define hookpost-echo
12793echo --->>>\n
12794end
12795
12796(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12797<<<---Hello World--->>>
12798(@value{GDBP})
12799
12800@end example
12801
c906108c
SS
12802You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12803not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12804name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12805@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12806@c or not?
12807If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12808@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12809(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
12810
12811If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12812get a warning from the @code{define} command.
12813
6d2ebf8b 12814@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
12815@section Command files
12816
12817@cindex command files
5d161b24
DB
12818A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12819commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12820An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
c906108c
SS
12821the last command, as it would from the terminal.
12822
12823@cindex init file
12824@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 12825@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c 12826When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
bf0184be
ND
12827@dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix and
12828@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. During startup, @value{GDBN} does the
12829following:
12830
12831@enumerate
12832@item
12833Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12834DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12835@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
12836
12837@item
12838Processes command line options and operands.
12839
12840@item
12841Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
12842
12843@item
12844Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12845@end enumerate
12846
12847The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12848complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12849and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12850option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 12851
c906108c
SS
12852@cindex init file name
12853On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12854different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12855form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12856different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12857environments with special init file names:
12858
00e4a2e4 12859@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c
SS
12860@itemize @bullet
12861@item
00e4a2e4 12862VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 12863
00e4a2e4 12864@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12865@item
00e4a2e4 12866OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12867
00e4a2e4 12868@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 12869@item
00e4a2e4 12870ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 12871@end itemize
c906108c
SS
12872
12873You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12874@code{source} command:
12875
12876@table @code
12877@kindex source
12878@item source @var{filename}
12879Execute the command file @var{filename}.
12880@end table
12881
12882The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
12883printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
12884of the command file.
12885
12886Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12887without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12888normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12889when called from command files.
12890
6d2ebf8b 12891@node Output
c906108c
SS
12892@section Commands for controlled output
12893
12894During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12895@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12896explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
12897describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12898want.
12899
12900@table @code
12901@kindex echo
12902@item echo @var{text}
12903@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12904@c because it is not in ANSI.
12905Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
12906@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12907newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12908In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12909by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
12910string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
5d161b24 12911trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
c906108c
SS
12912To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12913@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
12914
12915A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
12916the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
12917
12918@example
12919echo This is some text\n\
12920which is continued\n\
12921onto several lines.\n
12922@end example
12923
12924produces the same output as
12925
12926@example
12927echo This is some text\n
12928echo which is continued\n
12929echo onto several lines.\n
12930@end example
12931
12932@kindex output
12933@item output @var{expression}
12934Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12935newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
5d161b24 12936value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
c906108c
SS
12937on expressions.
12938
12939@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12940Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
12941the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12942formats}, for more information.
12943
12944@kindex printf
12945@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12946Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12947@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12948either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
12949@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12950subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
12951@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12952@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12953@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12954@c supported.
c906108c
SS
12955
12956@example
12957printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
12958@end example
12959
12960For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
12961
12962@smallexample
12963printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12964@end smallexample
12965
12966The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12967string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12968letter.
12969@end table
12970
6d2ebf8b 12971@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
12972@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
12973
12974@cindex Emacs
12975@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
12976A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
12977edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
12978@value{GDBN}.
12979
12980To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
12981executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
12982@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
12983created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 12984@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
12985
12986Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
12987things:
12988
12989@itemize @bullet
12990@item
12991All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
12992@end itemize
12993
12994This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
12995and output done by the program you are debugging.
12996
12997This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
12998commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
12999in this way.
13000
13001All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13002with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13003way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13004stop.
13005
13006@itemize @bullet
13007@item
13008@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13009@end itemize
13010
13011Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13012source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13013left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13014source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13015and the source.
13016
13017Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13018usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
13019
13020@quotation
13021@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13022current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13023the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13024appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13025environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13026session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13027back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13028avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13029your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13030@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
13031
13032A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13033switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13034@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13035@end quotation
13036
13037By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13038you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13039several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13040Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13041
13042@example
13043(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
13044@end example
13045
13046@noindent
d4f3574e 13047(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
13048in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13049``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13050
13051In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13052addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
13053
13054@table @kbd
13055@item C-h m
13056Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
13057
13058@item M-s
13059Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13060update the display window to show the current file and location.
13061
13062@item M-n
13063Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13064calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13065to show the current file and location.
13066
13067@item M-i
13068Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13069display window accordingly.
13070
13071@item M-x gdb-nexti
13072Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13073display window accordingly.
13074
13075@item C-c C-f
13076Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13077@code{finish} command.
13078
13079@item M-c
13080Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13081command.
13082
13083@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
13084
13085@item M-u
13086Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13087(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13088like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
13089
13090@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
13091
13092@item M-d
13093Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13094@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
13095
13096@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
13097
13098@item C-x &
13099Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13100of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13101around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13102then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13103argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
13104
13105You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13106@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13107otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13108inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13109wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13110list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13111formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13112is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13113@end table
13114
13115In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13116tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
13117
13118If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13119it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13120request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13121the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13122frame.
13123
13124The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13125which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13126the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13127communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13128delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13129to correspond properly with the code.
13130
13131@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13132@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13133@ignore
13134@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13135@kindex Epoch
13136@kindex inspect
13137
5d161b24 13138Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
c906108c
SS
13139called the @code{epoch}
13140environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13141@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13142each value is printed in its own window.
13143@end ignore
c906108c 13144
d700128c 13145@include annotate.texi
7162c0ca 13146@include gdbmi.texinfo
d700128c 13147
6d2ebf8b 13148@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
13149@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13150@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13151@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
13152
13153Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
13154
13155Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13156may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13157the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13158reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
13159
13160In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13161information that enables us to fix the bug.
13162
13163@menu
13164* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13165* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
13166@end menu
13167
6d2ebf8b 13168@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
13169@section Have you found a bug?
13170@cindex bug criteria
13171
13172If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
13173
13174@itemize @bullet
13175@cindex fatal signal
13176@cindex debugger crash
13177@cindex crash of debugger
13178@item
13179If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13180@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13181
13182@cindex error on valid input
13183@item
13184If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13185bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13186somewhere in the connection to the target.)
13187
13188@cindex invalid input
13189@item
13190If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13191that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13192``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13193for traditional practice''.
13194
13195@item
13196If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13197for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
13198@end itemize
13199
6d2ebf8b 13200@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
13201@section How to report bugs
13202@cindex bug reports
13203@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13204
c906108c
SS
13205A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13206If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13207contact that organization first.
13208
13209You can find contact information for many support companies and
13210individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13211distribution.
13212@c should add a web page ref...
13213
13214In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
13215@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
13216
13217@example
d4f3574e 13218bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
13219@end example
13220
13221@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 13222@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
13223not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13224@samp{bug-gdb}.
13225
13226The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13227serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13228the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13229newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13230problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13231path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13232we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13233bug reports to the mailing list.
13234
13235As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
13236
13237@example
13238@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
13239Free Software Foundation Inc.
1324059 Temple Place - Suite 330
13241Boston, MA 02111-1307
13242USA
13243@end example
c906108c
SS
13244
13245The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13246@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13247fact or leave it out, state it!
13248
13249Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13250problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13251assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13252Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13253stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13254name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13255of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13256the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13257easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
13258
13259Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13260bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13261you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13262self-contained.
13263
13264Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13265bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13266@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13267bugs properly.
13268
13269To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
13270
13271@itemize @bullet
13272@item
13273The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13274with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13275version}.
13276
13277Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13278the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
13279
13280@item
13281The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13282version number.
13283
c906108c
SS
13284@item
13285What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13286``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
13287
13288@item
13289What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13290debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13291C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13292information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13293compilers.
13294
13295@item
13296The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13297observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13298you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13299Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
13300
13301If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13302and then we might not encounter the bug.
13303
13304@item
13305A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13306reproduce the bug.
13307
13308@item
13309A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13310incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
13311
13312Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13313will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13314not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13315a chance to make a mistake.
13316
13317Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13318say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13319copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13320the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13321crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13322ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13323us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13324to draw any conclusion from our observations.
13325
c906108c
SS
13326@item
13327If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13328diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13329it by context, not by line number.
13330
13331The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13332sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 13333
c906108c
SS
13334@end itemize
13335
13336Here are some things that are not necessary:
13337
13338@itemize @bullet
13339@item
13340A description of the envelope of the bug.
13341
13342Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13343which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13344changes will not affect it.
13345
13346This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13347will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13348with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13349We recommend that you save your time for something else.
13350
13351Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13352of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13353output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13354less time, and so on.
13355
13356However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13357report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
13358
13359@item
13360A patch for the bug.
13361
13362A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13363the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13364a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13365to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
13366
13367Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13368construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13369through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13370to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
13371
13372And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13373patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13374help us to understand.
13375
13376@item
13377A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
13378
13379Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13380things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13381@end itemize
13382
5d161b24 13383@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
c906108c
SS
13384@c and consists of the two following files:
13385@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 13386@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
13387@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13388@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13389@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 13390@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
13391
13392
6d2ebf8b 13393@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
13394@appendix Formatting Documentation
13395
13396@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13397@cindex reference card
13398The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13399for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13400subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13401@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13402release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13403you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
13404
13405The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13406can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
13407
13408@example
13409make refcard.dvi
13410@end example
13411
5d161b24
DB
13412The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13413mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
c906108c
SS
13414that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13415high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13416your @sc{dvi} output program.
13417
13418@cindex documentation
13419
13420All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13421distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13422a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13423on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13424formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13425and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
13426
13427@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13428version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13429file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13430subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13431necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13432but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13433Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13434@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
13435
13436If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13437Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13438@code{makeinfo}.
13439
13440If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13441@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13442version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
13443
13444@example
13445cd gdb
13446make gdb.info
13447@end example
13448
13449If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13450a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13451Texinfo definitions file.
13452
13453@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13454produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13455document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13456has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13457command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13458(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13459require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
13460
13461@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13462@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13463written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13464typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13465and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13466directory.
13467
13468If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
13469typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
13470subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
13471@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
13472
13473@example
13474make gdb.dvi
13475@end example
13476
13477Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 13478
6d2ebf8b 13479@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
13480@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
13481@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
13482@cindex installation
13483
c906108c
SS
13484@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
13485of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
13486build the @code{gdb} program.
13487@iftex
13488@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
13489@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
13490look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
13491installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
13492@end iftex
13493
5d161b24
DB
13494The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
13495@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
c906108c
SS
13496appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
13497
13498For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
13499@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
13500
13501@table @code
13502@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
13503script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
13504
13505@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
13506the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
13507
13508@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13509source for the Binary File Descriptor library
13510
13511@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
13512@sc{gnu} include files
13513
13514@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
13515source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
13516
13517@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
13518source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
13519
13520@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
13521source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
13522
13523@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
13524source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
13525
13526@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
13527source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
13528@end table
13529
13530The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
13531from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
13532this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
13533
13534First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
13535if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
13536identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
13537argument.
13538
13539For example:
13540
13541@example
13542cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13543./configure @var{host}
13544make
13545@end example
13546
13547@noindent
13548where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
13549@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
13550(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
13551correct value by examining your system.)
13552
13553Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
13554@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
13555libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
13556binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
13557
13558@need 750
13559@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
13560system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
13561shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
13562
13563@example
13564sh configure @var{host}
13565@end example
13566
13567If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
13568directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
13569@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
13570creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
13571you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
13572
13573You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
13574subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
13575configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
13576
13577For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
13578the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
13579
13580@example
13581@group
13582cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13583../configure @var{host}
13584@end group
13585@end example
13586
13587You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
13588However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
13589the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
13590that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
13591let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
13592
13593@menu
13594* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13595* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
13596* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
13597@end menu
13598
6d2ebf8b 13599@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
13600@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13601
13602If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
13603you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
13604host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
13605allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
13606rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
13607handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
13608@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
13609program specified there.
13610
13611To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
13612with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
13613(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
13614itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
13615would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
13616the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
13617
5d161b24 13618For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
c906108c
SS
13619separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
13620
13621@example
13622@group
13623cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13624mkdir ../gdb-sun4
13625cd ../gdb-sun4
13626../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
13627make
13628@end group
13629@end example
13630
13631When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
13632directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
13633(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
13634the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
13635directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
13636@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
13637
13638One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
5d161b24
DB
13639directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
13640@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
13641programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
c906108c
SS
13642You specify a cross-debugging target by
13643giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
13644
13645When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
13646it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
13647called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
13648
13649The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
13650directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
13651directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
13652directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
13653will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
13654
13655When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
13656directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
13657if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
13658with each other.
13659
6d2ebf8b 13660@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
13661@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
13662
13663The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
13664script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
13665aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
13666of information in the following pattern:
13667
13668@example
13669@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
13670@end example
13671
13672For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
13673or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
13674option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
13675
13676The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
13677any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
13678aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
13679@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
13680script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
13681abbreviations---for example:
13682
13683@smallexample
13684% sh config.sub i386-linux
13685i386-pc-linux-gnu
13686% sh config.sub alpha-linux
13687alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
13688% sh config.sub hp9k700
13689hppa1.1-hp-hpux
13690% sh config.sub sun4
13691sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
13692% sh config.sub sun3
13693m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
13694% sh config.sub i986v
13695Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
13696@end smallexample
13697
13698@noindent
13699@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
13700directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
13701
6d2ebf8b 13702@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
13703@section @code{configure} options
13704
13705Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
13706are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
13707several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
13708Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
13709
13710@example
13711configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
13712 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13713 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13714 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
13715 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
13716 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
13717 @var{host}
13718@end example
13719
13720@noindent
13721You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
13722@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
13723@samp{--}.
13724
13725@table @code
13726@item --help
13727Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
13728
13729@item --prefix=@var{dir}
13730Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
13731@file{@var{dir}}.
13732
13733@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
13734Configure the source to install programs under directory
13735@file{@var{dir}}.
13736
13737@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
13738@need 2000
13739@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
13740@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
13741@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
13742Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
13743@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
13744build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
13745directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
13746the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
13747directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
13748the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
13749@var{dirname}.
13750
13751@item --norecursion
13752Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
13753propagate configuration to subdirectories.
13754
13755@item --target=@var{target}
13756Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
13757@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
13758programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
13759
13760There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
13761
13762@item @var{host} @dots{}
13763Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
13764
13765There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
13766@end table
13767
13768There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
13769needed for special purposes only.
5d161b24 13770
6d2ebf8b 13771@node Index
c906108c
SS
13772@unnumbered Index
13773
13774@printindex cp
13775
13776@tex
13777% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
13778% meantime:
13779\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
13780\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
13781\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
13782\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
13783\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
13784\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
13785\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
13786\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
13787\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
13788\page\colophon
13789% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
13790@end tex
13791
449f3b6c
AC
13792@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
13793@ifinfo
c906108c 13794@contents
449f3b6c
AC
13795@end ifinfo
13796@ifhtml
13797@contents
13798@end ifhtml
13799
c906108c 13800@bye
This page took 0.74406 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.